Digital Disk Recorders
Operating Instructions
WJ-HD309
Model Nos.
WJ-HD316
M
ONITO
R1
TIMER
MONITOR2
ALARM
ERROR
1
5
9
STOP
2
6
PLAY
3
SHIFT
PAUSE
ALARM
4
8
REC-
-
REC STOP
SUSPEND
SEQ
ALARM
RESET
PAN/
TILT
OSD
GOTO
LAST
7
REV
SEARCH
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
PULL
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
COPY
FWD
TEXT
A-B
REPEAT
OPERATE
MARK
SETUP
/ESC
HDD
1
10/0
14
11
15
12
IRIS
HDD
2
LISTED
-
LOGOUT
13
PRESET
/AUTO
+
16
BUSY
SET
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
316
Before attempting to connect or operate this product,
please read these instructions carefully and save this manual for future use.
CONTENTS
PREFACE .................................................................... 4
OPERATION OF THE UNIT IN THE CASCADE
FEATURES .................................................................. 4
PRECAUTIONS ........................................................... 5
TRADEMARKS AND REGISTERED
TRADEMARKS ............................................................ 6
ABOUT THESE OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS ......... 6
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY ......................................... 6
MAJOR OPERATING CONTROLS AND
THEIR FUNCTIONS .................................................... 7
I Front View ............................................................. 7
I Rear View ............................................................. 9
I On Monitor 1 (To display only live image) ............. 10
I On Monitor 2
(To display live or recorded image) ....................... 11
STARTUP .................................................................... 16
CLOCK ADJUSTMENT ............................................... 17
SHUTDOWN ................................................................ 18
RECORDING (Manual Recording) .............................. 19
RECORDING (Emergency Recording) ........................ 21
PLAYBACK .................................................................. 22
PLAYBACK IMAGE ON A DESIGNATED DISK .......... 25
PLAYBACK FROM A DESIGNATED
CONNECTION ............................................................. 63
I Features ................................................................ 63
I Operation using the buttons on the front panel ..... 63
I Operation using a system controller ..................... 63
INSTALLATION IN THE RACK ................................... 64
MANAGEMENT OF USERS/HOSTS .......................... 65
OPERATING THE UNIT FOR THE FIRST TIME ........ 67
Preparation for maintenance (HDD replacement,
installation, etc.) ........................................................... 68
CONNECTIONS .......................................................... 70
I Connections when the unit is used
independently ........................................................ 70
I Connections with an extension unit ...................... 71
I Connections with DVD-RAM, CD-R, and
DVD-R drives ........................................................ 72
I Connections with the VTR .................................... 73
I Connections with PS·Data systems ...................... 74
I Cascade connection of multiple units ................... 76
I Connection with the RS485 camera ..................... 80
I Mode Switch ......................................................... 82
I RS485 Port ........................................................... 82
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM/
TIME AND DATE ......................................................... 27
SEARCH AND PLAY ................................................... 28
I Search for a Recording Event and Play it back
CONTROL Connector ........................................... 83
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM
(Recording Event Search) ..................................... 28
I Search for a motion detected time and date from
recorded images and play it (VMD search) ........... 32
I To delete the motion detection area ..................... 36
I Search for a marked point and play from that point
(Marking search) ................................................... 37
MONITOR LIVE IMAGES ............................................ 38
I Displaying Live Images on a Single Screen .......... 38
I Electronic Zoom .................................................... 38
I Displaying on a Multi-screen ................................. 39
I Sequential Display ................................................ 40
CONTROL CAMERAS ................................................ 41
I Panning/Tilting ...................................................... 41
I Zoom ..................................................................... 41
I Focus .................................................................... 41
I Iris ......................................................................... 42
I Preset Action ......................................................... 42
I Move a camera to the preset position ................... 43
I Auto Function (Auto Pan, etc) ............................... 44
ABOUT THE EVENT FUNCTION ................................ 45
I Action at an event occurrence .............................. 45
I Alarm Function ...................................................... 46
I Cancel the Alarm Action ....................................... 47
I Suspend the Alarm Actions ................................... 47
COPYING (Duplicate) .................................................. 48
DELETE DATA ON THE DISK .................................... 50
I Deletion of recorded images saved on the
Connector ............................................................. 87
I How to Use the SERIAL Connector ...................... 89
SETUP ......................................................................... 90
I Item list of the SETUP MENU ............................... 90
I About the SETUP MENU ...................................... 92
I Basic Operation with the SETUP MENU .............. 93
I [Maintenance] Functions for Maintaining .............. 94
I [Recording] ............................................................ 98
I [Event] Function for Events ................................. 100
I [Schedule] Settings for the recording/
event action schedule ......................................... 105
I [Switcher] Settings for the switcher function ....... 110
I [Display] .............................................................. 113
I [Comm] Settings for communication with other
devices ................................................................ 116
I [System] Settings on System .............................. 121
DISPLAY SETUP MENU OF CAMERA ..................... 127
DISK MANAGEMENT ................................................ 128
I Notes on hard disk .............................................. 128
I How to replace the built-in hard disk ................... 128
I About the HDD DISK MENU ............................... 131
I Display of the HDD DISK MENU ........................ 131
I RAID 5 Function of the Extension Unit ............... 132
I Formatting (Initialization) the Hard Disk .............. 133
I Setting for Mirroring ............................................ 137
SERIAL (RS232C) CONNECTOR COMMAND
REFERENCE ............................................................. 141
I SERIAL (RS232C) Communication Protocol ...... 141
I Command Format ............................................... 141
FLOWCHART OF THE SETUP MENU ...................... 151
PARAMETERS AND THE DEFAULT SETTINGS
OF THE SETUP MENU ............................................. 152
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................... 158
SPECIFICATION ....................................................... 162
STANDARD ACCESSORIES .................................... 163
hard disk manually ................................................ 50
FORMAT (INITIALIZE) A DVD-RAM DISK .................. 52
DISPLAY/EDIT TEXT INFORMATION ........................ 54
ERROR/WARNINGS ................................................... 56
OPERATION USING A SYSTEM CONTROLLER ...... 58
OPERATION USING A PC .......................................... 62
I Features ................................................................ 62
I System Requirements of a PC ...............................62
3
PREFACE
The Digital Disk Recorders WJ-HD316/309 are designed for
use within a surveillance system and are a combination of a
hard disk recorder and a video multiplexer (16-input for the
WJ-HD316, 9-input for the WJ-HD309).
The digital hard disk recorder is a recording device using a
hard disk drive to record camera pictures instead of using
videotapes so that pictures recorded by repeated overwrit-
ing will not experience deterioration of the recorded picture
quality. Up to 16 cameras can be connected to the WJ-
HD316 directly (up to 9 cameras to the WJ-HD309) and it is
possible to record their camera pictures. It is also possible
to display four or more camera pictures on a single monitor,
to switch camera pictures, and to operate cameras using
this unit.
FEATURES
Various Recording Functions
Remote Operation via Network
• Multi-Recording
It is possible to operate this unit using a PC connected to a
LAN (Local Area Network) or the Internet with the featured
network function.
It is possible to perform multiple recordings using a sin-
gle digital disk recorder even if the operating environ-
ments are different, for example, recording pictures of
cameras in different places at different times.
Security Function and Reliability
• Schedule recording
• Authentication function (registration of ID and pass-
word) allows users access to a predetermined selection
of the available functions. Up to 32 users can be regis-
tered.
It is possible to perform recording automatically at a
scheduled time on a designated day of the week.
Schedules can be set on each camera.
• Emergency Recording
• If alteration of a recorded image data is made for any
reason, the alteration alert function will announce it.
In the case of an emergency, emergency recordings
will be given a higher priority than other recording
modes by operating an external switch.
• If a hard disk crashes, the backup function*1, the mirror-
ing function*2 and the RAID 5 function*3 prevent any
data loss.
• External Timer Recording
It is possible to perform recording automatically using
an external timer.
*1: Only when the recommended DVD-RAM drive, DVD-R
drive or CD-R drive is used
*2: The mirroring function does not work with an external
hard disk drive such as an extension unit.
*3: To use the RAID 5 function, an optional extension unit is
required.
• Event Recording
At an event occurrence, such as when an alarm signal
is supplied, the recording mode (quality and recording
rate) can be changed to high quality to record pictures.
• Motion Detection Function (VMD)
It is possible to start recording automatically when
motion is detected in a shooting area.
Transmission with Coaxial Cable, PS·Data and
RS485 Compatible
• It is possible to control a Panasonic combination cam-
era such as the WV-CS850 using only a coaxial cable
but not other devices. Using a coaxial cable also com-
pensates for transmission loss.
• It is easy to establish the surveillance system by con-
necting a PS·Data compatible system controller and
peripherals.
Frame Switcher Function
• It is possible to display pictures of four or more cam-
eras on a single monitor (multi-screen) splitting the
monitor screen into 4, 7, 9, 10, 13, or 16 sections using
the WJ-HD316, and into 4, 7, or 9 sections using the
WJ-HD309.
While monitoring a multi-screen, each camera picture
will be displayed as a moving image.
4
PRECAUTIONS
• Refer all work related to the installation of these
products to qualified service personnel or system
installers.
• Built-in hard disk drives
Hard disk drives are vulnerable to vibration. Handle
them with care.
It is possible to damage them if they are moved while
their motors are still running. Do not move them just
after turning their power on or off (for around 30 sec-
onds).
Hard disk drives are perishable. They will need to be
replaced after around 20 000 - 30 000 hours of opera-
tion in case they are used at temperature of 25°C
(77°F).
Replacement costs of the hard disk drives are not cov-
ered by the warranty even if it needs to be done within
the warranty period. Consult your dealer for servicing.
When hard disk drive trouble occurs, replace it immedi-
ately. Consult your dealer for servicing.
• Do not operate the appliances beyond their speci-
fied temperature, humidity, or power source ratings.
Use the appliance at temperatures within +5°C -
+45°C (41°F - 113°F) and humidity below 85 %.
The input power source for this appliance is 220 V -
240 V AC 50 Hz.
Performance and lifetime of hard disk drives are easily
affected by heat (used at high temperature) character-
istically. It is recommended to use this appliance at
temperatures within +20 °C - +30 °C (68 °F - 86 °F).
• Handle the appliance with care.
Do not strike or shake, as this may damage the appli-
ance.
When replacing the hard disk drives, take notice of the
following.
Do not detach the hard disk drives or the cables con-
necting the unit and the front cover while the
HDD1/HDD2 indicators are lit or for around 30 seconds
after the indicators go off.
• Do not strike or give a strong shock to the unit.
It may cause damage or allow water to enter the unit.
• Built-in backup battery
Protect the hard disk drives from static electricity.
Do not stack them, or keep them upright.
Do not use an electric screwdriver to fix them.
(Tightening torque: Approx. 0.49 N · m (5 kgf · cm))
Avoid rapid changes of the temperature/humidity to
prevent condensation. (Acceptable change: within
15°C/h (59°F/h))
Before the first use, charge the built-in backup battery
(lithium battery) by turning on the power for 48 hours or
more.
If it is not charged enough, in a case where the power
goes down, the internal clock may keep bad time or the
operative condition may be different to that before the
electric power failure.
The built-in battery life is approximately 5 years as an
indication of replacement. (This is just an indication of
replacement. We are not providing any guarantee of the
built-in battery lifetime. Replacement cost of the built-in
battery is not covered by the warranty even if it needs
to be done within the warranty period.) Ask the shop
where you purchased the unit when replacement of the
battery is required.
• Avoid placing receptacles that contain liquids such as
water near the unit.
If liquid spills onto the unit, it may cause fire or an elec-
tric shock.
• Do not expose the unit to water or moisture, or try to
operate it in wet areas.
• Prevent condensation from forming on the surface of
the hard disk.
• Cooling Fan
Turn the power off when cleaning the unit. Otherwise it
may cause injuries.
Replacement costs of the cooling fan are not covered
by the warranty even if it needs to be done within the
warranty period. Consult your dealer for servicing.
If this happens, do not turn on the power of the recorder
and leave the recorder for around 2 hours.
Wait until the dew evaporates in any of the following
cases:
• The recorder is placed in an extremely humid place.
• The recorder is placed in a room where a heater has
just been turned on.
• Cleaning
Turn the power off when cleaning the unit. Otherwise it
may cause injuries.
Do not use strong or abrasive detergents when clean-
ing the appliance body.
Use a dry cloth to clean the appliance when it is dirty.
When the dirt is hard to remove, use a mild detergent
and wipe gently.
• The recorder is moved from an air-conditioned room
to a humid and high-temperature room.
• We recommend that you make a note of your settings
and save them. This will help when you are required to
change the system configuration, or when unexpected
trouble or failure occurs.
• Indication label
• Distributing, copying, disassembling, reverse compil-
ing, reverse engineering, and also exporting in violation
of export laws of the software provided with this prod-
uct, is expressly prohibited.
Refer to the indication labels placed on the top and but-
tom of the unit as to the indications of equipment classi-
fication and power source, etc.
5
TRADEMARKS AND REGISTERED TRADEMARKS
• Adobe, Adobe logos, and Acrobat are registered trade-
marks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the U.S. and/
or other countries.
• Microsoft, Windows and Windows XP are registered
trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or
other countries.
• Other names of companies and products contained in
these operating instructions may be trademarks or reg-
istered trademarks of their respective owners.
ABOUT THESE OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS
There are 3 sets of operating instructions for the WJ-
HD316/WJ-HD309 as follows.
• Operating Instructions (book, these operating instruc-
tions)
• Network Operating Instructions (PDF)
• Network Setup Instructions (PDF)
Refer to the "Network Setup Instructions" on the provided
CD-ROM for descriptions of how to perform the required
settings and how to connect to other devices.
Adobe® Reader is required to read these operating instruc-
tions (PDF) on the provided CD-ROM. When the Adobe®
Reader is not installed on the PC, download the latest
Adobe® Reader from the Adobe web site and install it.
These "Operating Instructions" contain descriptions of how
to operate this unit with the buttons on the front panel.
Refer to the "Network Operating Instructions" on the provid-
ed CD-ROM for descriptions of how to operate this unit
from a PC.
"WJ-HD300" or "HD300" shown in the illustrations used in
these operating instructions indicate this unit or the WJ-
HD300 series.
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
IN NO EVENT SHALL MATSUSHITA ELECTRIC INDUSTRI-
AL CO., LTD. BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY OR ANY PER-
SON, EXCEPT FOR REPLACEMENT OR REASONABLE
MAINTENANCE OF THE PRODUCT, FOR THE CASES,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO BELOW:
(2) PERSONAL INJURY OR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY
INAPPROPRIATE USE OR NEGLIGENT OPERATION
OF THE USER;
(3) UNAUTHORIZED DISASSEMBLE, REPAIR OR MODIFI-
CATION OF THE PRODUCT BY THE USER;
(4) ANY PROBLEM, CONSEQUENTIAL INCONVENIENCE,
OR LOSS OR DAMAGE, ARISING OUT OF THE SYS-
TEM COMBINED BY THE DEVICES OF THIRD PARTY.
(1) ANY DAMAGE AND LOSS, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIM-
ITATION, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSE-
QUENTIAL OR EXEMPLARY, ARISING OUT OF OR
RELATING TO THE PRODUCT;
6
MAJOR OPERATING CONTROLS AND THEIR FUNCTIONS
I Front View
o
! ! @
! ! ! !
t
qw er yu i
!
@
@ @ @
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
S-VIDEO
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
VIDEO
OUT
COPY
2
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
REPEAT
–
+
SUSPEND
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
[WJ-HD316]
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
AUDIO
OUT
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
HDD
2
SET
13
BUSY
! !! @
@
@
@ @
#
o
! ! @
! ! ! !
t
qw er yu i
!
@
@ @ @
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
TIMER
1
4
7
2
3
6
9
S-VIDEO
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
OSD
VIDEO
OUT
COPY
2
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
5
8
0
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
REPEAT
–
+
SUSPEND
ALARM
RESET
[WJ-HD309]
COPY
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
AUDIO
OUT
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
HDD
2
SET
BUSY
!! @
@
@
@ @
#
!
q Operate Indicator (OPERATE)
Lights up when the power is turned on.
u HDD Access Indicators (HDD1/HDD2)
Blinks when the HDD1 or the HDD2 is accessed
respectively.
w Alarm Suspension Indicator (ALARM SUSPEND)
Lights up when the alarm suspension mode is selected.
i Monitor Switch button (MONITOR1/MONITOR2)
Pressing this button switches the monitor. This button
lights up when monitor 1 is selected, and goes off when
monitor 2 or the VGA monitor is selected.
e Alarm Indicator (ALARM)
Blinks when an alarm occurs, and lights steadily when
the activated alarm is reset automatically.
To turn this indicator off, press the ALARM RESET but-
ton.
o Shift Button (SHIFT)
Toggles the functions of the camera selection buttons.
r Alarm Reset Button (ALARM RESET)
Pressing this button cancels alarm activation, and
returns the system to the condition before the alarm
was activated.
! Camera Selection Buttons ([1] - [10/0], [11] - [16] for
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309)
Pressing a button displays live or playback images of
the selected camera. The LED in the button indicates
the status as follows.
t Error indicator (ERROR)
Green: When a button is lit green, the currently dis-
played image on the monitor is live from the respec-
tive camera.
Blinks orange when an error occurs that will not keep
the unit from running.
Blinks red when an error occurs that may cause the
system to go down.
Orange: When a button is lit orange, the image from the
respective camera is recorded.
Refer to page 56 for further information about error/
warnings.
Blue: When a button is lit blue, the currently displayed
image on the monitor is live from the respective
camera and is also recorded.
y Timer Indicator (TIMER)
Lights up when the schedule recording is set, and
blinks while the schedule recording is being performed.
7
When the shift button is lit, these buttons work as the
toggled function buttons.
(The buttons available as the toggled function buttons
will light green when the shift button is lit.)
@ Set Button (SET)
Works differently depending on the situations listed
below:
• Plays recorded images at the current playback speed
when this button is pressed during fast playback.
• Registers preset positions of cameras.
• Activates the auto focus function.
• Sets the alarm suspension mode on/off.
• Determines the setting of parameters on the setup
menus.
! Pan, Tilt, Latest Recorded Image Playback Button
(PAN/TILT, GO TO LAST)
Pans/tilts the selected camera, or plays back the latest
recorded image.
(Refer to pages 41 and 23 respectively.)
! Zoom, Focus, A - B Repeat Button (ZOOM/FOCUS,
A-B REPEAT)
@ Jog Dial
Works differently depending on the situations as fol-
lows:
• Plays recorded images frame by frame when this dial is
rotated during pausing playback.
Zooms in/out, adjusts focus, or repeats playback of
recorded images between two designated points.
(Refer to pages 41 and 24 respectively.)
• Skips playback time when this dial is rotated during
playback at normal speed.
! Iris, Listing Button (IRIS, LISTED)
Adjusts iris, or enables/disables the filtering playback.
(Refer to pages 42 and 28 respectively.)
• Moves the cursor on the search menu or the thumbnail
menu.
• Selects a parameter setting or a character on the setup
menus.
! Preset, Auto Function Button (PRESET/AUTO)
Moves a camera to the preset position, or activates the
auto function of the camera.
@ Shuttle Ring
(Refer to pages 42 and 44 respectively.)
Works differently depending on the situations as fol-
lows:
! Stop Button (STOP)
• Plays fast when this dial is rotated during playback at
Stops playback.
normal speed.
• Turns the search menu pages or the thumbnail menu
pages.
! Play/Pause Button (PLAY/PAUSE)
Plays recorded images, or pauses playback.
@ Connectors Cover
! Record Button (REC/REC STOP)
Starts recording. To stop recording, press this button
down for 2 seconds or more.
@ Copy Port (COPY2)
Connect a recommended external recording device to
this port.
! Slow Button (SLOW)
Pans/tilts the selected camera slowly.
@ S-Video Output Connector (S-VIDEO)
Connect the S-video input connector of a VTR with this
connector. The same video signal supplied to the MON-
ITOR OUT2 connector on the rear panel will be sup-
plied to this connector.
! Search Button (SEARCH)
Displays the search menu.
@ Setup, Escape Button (SETUP/ESC)
Displays the setup menu, or turns back to the previous
page of the setup menu, etc.
@ Video Output Connector (VIDEO OUT)
Connect the video input connector of a VTR with this
connector. The same video signal supplied to the MON-
ITOR OUT2 connector on the rear panel will be sup-
plied to this connector.
@ Busy Indicator (BUSY)
Lights when the selected camera was not available to
operate because another user is operating it using a
controller or a PC via a network. In this case, wait until
this indicator goes off.
# Audio Output Connector (AUDIO OUT)
This connector, for an RCA standard jack, supplies an
unbalanced –10 dBV, 600 Ω line output audio signal to
an external device.
@ Arrow Buttons (CDAB)
Adjusts zooming/focus, or moves the cursor on the
setup menus and the search menu.
Recorded audio will be supplied from this connector
during playback.
The same audio signal supplied to the AUDIO OUT
connector on the rear panel will be supplied to this con-
nector.
8
I Rear View
o !
!
!
!
!
q w
t y ui
e
! !
!
!
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
2
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
15
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
[WJ-HD316]
16
14
14
13
12
11
10
10
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
r
!
!
o !
!
!
!
q w
t y ui
e
! !
!
!
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
MODE
2
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
2
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
IN
ALARM/CONTOROL
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
9
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
[WJ-HD309]
OUT
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
r
!
q Audio Input Connectors (AUDIO IN 1 - 4)
t Monitor Output Connector (MONITOR OUT1, MONI-
TOR OUT2/CASCADE OUT)
These connectors, for RCA pin jacks, accept an unbal-
anced –10 dBV, 10 kΩ line input audio signal supplied
from an external device such as a microphone amplifi-
er.
Connect monitors to these BNC connectors.
The MONITOR OUT2 connector can also be used as
the CASCADE OUT connector.
When using two or more units of the WJ-HD316/WJ-
HD309 and using the MONITOR OUT2 connector as
the CASCADE OUT connector, connect with the CAS-
CADE IN connector of another WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309.
w Audio Output Connector (AUDIO OUT)
This connector, for an RCA standard jack, supplies an
unbalanced –10 dBV, 600 Ω line output audio signal to
an external device.
Recorded audio will be supplied from this connector
during playback.
y Cascade In Connector (CASCADE IN)
Connect with the CASCADE OUT connector of another
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using two or more units of
the WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309.
e Video Input Connectors (CAMERA IN 1 - 16 for the
WJ-HD316/CAMERA IN 1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309)
Connect system cameras or combination cameras to
these BNC connectors.
u Serial Connector (SERIAL)
Connect a PC with this D-Sub 9-pin connector when
controlling this unit.
A 75 Ω termination is made unless the video output ter-
minal is connected.
To connect combination cameras, connect them to the
CAMERA IN 1 - 8 connectors of the WJ-HD316, or the
CAMERA IN 1 - 6 of the WJ-HD309 (accept coaxial
communication).
i Monitor Connector (MONITOR (VGA))
Connect a VGA monitor with this connector. The same
video signal supplied to the MONITOR OUT2 connector
will be supplied to this connector.
r Video Output Connectors (CAMERA OUT 1 - 16 for
the WJ-HD316/CAMERA OUT 1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309)
These BNC connectors supply video signals looped
through the video input connectors.
IMPORTANT
For European Customers
The refresh rate of the video output signal supplied from the
MONITOR (VGA) connector is 50 Hz. Some VGA monitors
in Europe may not support this refresh rate and could be
damaged. Please check the refresh rate supported by your
VGA monitor before connecting.
Note: Video signals will not be supplied from the CAM-
ERA OUT 1 - 8 connectors (CAMERA OUT 1 - 6
connectors for the WJ-HD309) if the power of the
unit is off.
9
Please check the documentation supplied with your monitor
to see if your VGA monitor supports a refresh rate of 50 Hz.
If your VGA monitor does not support 50 Hz (or if you are
not sure), then turn off your VGA monitor before turning on
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using your television as a dis-
play.
I On Monitor 1 (To display only
live image)
q
q
we
we
o Alarm Connector (ALARM)
Connect an external device such as a sensor or a door
switch with this D-Sub 25-pin connector.
q
! Alarm/Control Connector (ALARM/CONTROL)
Connect a control switch with this D-Sub 25-pin con-
nector when controlling this unit using an external
device, or when controlling an alarm device such as a
buzzer or a lamp.
q
q
we
we
The negative circled numbers indicate the default positions
of camera title q, time w and event display e.
! PS·Data Ports (DATA)
Connect PS·Data compatible devices with these ports.
Important:
! Mode Switches (MODE)
• The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and
the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP
MENU on monitor 1.)
Set the operation mode of this unit with these dip
switches.
• It will take around 2 minutes to display live images on
monitor 1 after turning on the power of the unit.
! RS485 Ports (RS485 (CAMERA))
Connect RS485 compatible combination cameras with
these ports.
1. Camera Title
Displays the edited camera title.
A position to display the camera title can be selected
from the following.
Upper left, upper right, lower left, lower right, centre
The default camera title position is lower right (R-
LOWER).
! Network Port (10/100BASE-T)
Connect this unit to a network compatible with 10BASE-
T or 100BASE-Tx when controlling this unit using a PC
via a network.
! Copy Port (COPY1)
Connect a recommended external recording device to
this port.
Note: The camera title will be displayed with 16 charac-
ters (2 lines: 8 characters per line).
! Extra Storage Port (EXT STORAGE)
Connect an optional extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series)
with this port.
2. Time
Displays the current time (hour:minute:second) and
date (day:month:year).
A position to display the time can be selected from the
following.
Centre, upper left, lower left, upper right, lower right
The default time display position is upper left (L-
UPPER).
! Power Switch (POWER)
Turns the power of this unit on and off.
! Signal Ground Terminal (SIGNAL GND)
! Power Cord Inlet (AC IN)
Notes:
Connect the power cord to this inlet.
• When the camera title and the time display are lay-
ered, only the time display will be displayed.
• When monitor 1 is selected, it is possible to turn
on/off display of the camera title and the time by
pressing the camera selection button 8 for the WJ-
HD316 (the camera selection button 6 for the WJ-
HD309) while the shift function is on (by pressing
the SHIFT button).
10
3. Event Display
Important:
When an event has occurred, an event display will be
displayed.
• Since the VGA output from this unit is the same as for
televisions (720 H x 576 V pixels/vertical frequency of
50 Hz), it may be possible that both the left and right
edges can not fit onto the screen depending on the
VGA monitor.
• It is impossible to use the MONITOR (VGA) connector
when connecting the unit in the cascade connection.
• It may take time to display live images on the VGA mon-
itor if the VGA monitor is turned on/off when the unit is
running.
The position of an event display will be symmetrical to
the position where the time is displayed. When the time
is displayed at the lower left of the screen, an event dis-
play will be displayed at the upper right corner of the
screen. The default position of an event display is the
upper right corner of the screen (R-UPPER).
The event display will be displayed differently as follows
depending on which event has occurred.
VMD-*: When motion is detected.
LOSS-*: When video loss has occurred.
COM-#: When a command alarm has occurred.
TRM-#: When a terminal alarm has occurred.
IMPORTANT
For European Customers
Some VGA monitors in Europe cannot be used simultane-
ously with television display. When you enable television
display in Europe, the refresh rate for the monitor and tele-
vision is set to 50Hz. Some VGA monitors may not support
this refresh rate and could be damaged.
• Please check the documentation supplied with your
monitor to see if your VGA monitor supports a refresh
rate of 50 Hz.
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for
the WJ-HD309)
#: Alarm number
Note: Refer to page 45 for further information about
event types and event actions.
If your VGA monitor does not support 50 Hz (or if you
are not sure), then turn off your VGA monitor before
turning on WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using your tele-
vision as a display.
I On Monitor 2 (To display live or
recorded images)
1. Camera Title
Displays the edited camera title.
A position to display the camera title can be selected
from the following.
Upper left, upper right, lower left, lower right, centre
The default camera title position is lower right (R-
LOWER).
q
q
q
w
w
q
B
C
2. Task Bar
q
Displays the current status.
The task bar consists of the main bar (w - A), the left
bar (w - B), and the right bar (w - C).
There are 3 different ways to display the task bar as fol-
lows.
w – A
The negative circled number q indicates the camera title
default position.
Mode 1
Notes:
Displays only the main bar and the status is displayed
on it.
• The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be dis-
played on the VGA monitor.
• The camera title will be displayed with 16 characters (2
lines: 8 characters per line).
• When monitor 2 is selected, it is possible to switch the
way of displaying the camera title in the following order
by pressing the camera selection button 8 for the WJ-
HD316 (the camera selection button 6 for the WJ-
HD309) while the shift function is on (by pressing the
SHIFT button):
Display the camera title → Display the camera title in
list form → Not display the camera title
11
Note: When the camera title and the task bar are lay-
ered in this mode, only the task bar will be dis-
played.
Mode 2
Displays the status on the main bar, the left bar and the
right bar.
Mode 3
Displays the status only on the main bar, and does not
display information on the left bar and the right bar.
Note: Mode 2 and Mode 3 are graphic operated. They
may not be as clear as Mode 1.
12
ꢀ Status on the Task Bar
• On the Main Bar
q Status Display Area
e Live/Playback Time Display Area
t Error Display Area
w Copy/Delete Icons
r Alarm Display Area
q Status Display Area
Indicated Item
Live
Status
Indication
Indicates the live image display status
: Live image is displayed
: Live images are displayed
sequentially
Playback
Indicates that playback is currently being performed
with the displayed playback speed
5: Currently playing
4: Currently playing in reverse
h: Currently pausing
2
: Currently playing at fast speed
: Currently playing in reverse at fast
1
speed
Recording
Search
Indicates that recording is currently being performed
Indicates that searching is currently being performed
: Currently recording
: Currently searching
w Copy/Delete Icons
Indicated Item
Copy
Status
Indication
Indicates that data copy is currently being performed
: Currently copying
Delete
Indicates that data deletion is currently being per-
formed
: Currently deleting data
e Live/Playback Time Display Area
Indicated Item
Status
Indication
Time
Displays time and date of the displayed image
When displaying live image: Current time and
date
When playing recorded image: Time and date
when recorded
Year:Month:Day
Hour:Minute:Second
*: During summer time, an asterisk (*) will be dis-
played on the left side of the displayed time.
13
r Alarm Display Area
Indicated Item
Alarm
Status
Indication
Indicates that an alarm has occurred
VMD-*: When motion is detected
LOSS-*: When video loss has occurred
COM-*: When a command alarm has occurred
TRM-*: When a terminal alarm has occurred
Alarm type
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for
the WJ-HD309)
#: Alarm number
Alarm is occurring currently
Note: Refer to page 45 for further information about event types and event actions.
t Error Display Area
Indicated Item
Status
Indication
Error Warning
Indicates an error occurrence or warning
ALT-*: Alteration is detected
W-ERROR: Failed to write data on the HDD
SMART: Warning of the HDD malfunction
H-METER: Set time for hour-meter (active time of
the HDD) warning has passed
Error type
THERMAL: The temperature inside the unit is too
high
Error is occurring currently
POWER: A power outage has been detected
#-nn%: Warning about running out of disk space
while displaying available disk space per-
centage
#-FULL: No available disk space
MEDIUM-n: An error occurred in an external
recording device
REMOVE: The hard disk is removed from the sys-
tem automatically because of an access error
FAN: The fan is faulty
Abbreviation of partition
Status
Displayed
abbreviation
NML
EVT
CPY
Normal recording area
Event recording area
Copy area
External recording device
connected to the COPY1 port
on the rear panel
External recording device
connected to the COPY2 port
on the front panel
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9
for the WJ-HD309)
#: Abbreviation that indicates partition
nn: Available disk size
CP1
CP2
n: Number of connector that an external recording
device is connected to
Note: Refer to page 56 for further information about error types and what to do when an error has occurred.
14
• On the Left Bar
Indicated Item
Status
Indication
Camera
Indicates recording and displaying status
Grey: Camera currently not displayed or not con-
nected to the respective channel
Green: Camera displayed on the monitor
Orange: Camera currently being recorded
Blue: Camera currently being recorded and dis-
played on the monitor
Camera 1 is on the top and camera
16 is on the bottom
• On the Right Bar
Indicated Item
Status
Indication
Used disk space
Indicates the available disk space of each partition.
Top: 100 % of the disk space is being used (no
available disk space)
Second from the top: 80 % of the disk space is
being used
Centre: 60 % of the disk space is being used
Second from the bottom: 40 % of the disk space
is being used
Normal Recording Area
Event Recording Area
Bottom: 20 % of the disk space is being used
Note: When "CONTINUE" is selected on the "Disk End
Mode" page of the "Maintenance" setup menu, the
available disk space will not be displayed. Refer
to a system administrator for further information.
NML: Available disk space of the normal record-
ing area used for manual recording and
schedule recording
EVT: Available disk space of the event recording
area used for event recording and emergency
recording
15
STARTUP
z Insert the power plug to an outlet (AC 220 V -
c Enter a user name and password.
240 V, 50 Hz)
Note: Make sure the power source is AC 220 V - 240 V,
50 Hz.
x Turn on the power switch on the rear panel.
The OPERATE indicator will light and the system check
(checking the system and hard disk) will start.
The startup splash image below will be displayed on moni-
tor 2 and the VGA monitor during the system check.
Rotate the jog dial to select a character to be entered in the
cursor position.
It is also possible to enter numbers by pressing the camera
selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9],
[0] for the WJ-HD309).
To move the cursor, press the arrow buttons.
Use the same method to enter or edit characters attached
to images. Refer to page 54 for further information.
Notes:
• The default user name and password are as follows:
User name: ADMIN
Password: 12345
When the auto login is off, the login window will be dis-
played if any button on the front panel of this unit is pressed
after the system check. (Go to step 3)
When the auto login is on, live images will be displayed
after the system check.
• To enhance the security, change the password for an
administrator before starting to run the unit. It is recom-
mended to change the password for an administrator
periodically.
• To log out, press the LOGOUT button after confirming
that the SHIFT indicator is lit.
Notes:
• If the hard disk configuration was changed after the last
startup or the hard disk has problems, the HDD DISK
MENU will be displayed automatically after the startup
splash. (Refer to page 131 for further information.)
• It is possible to display the disk configuration menu by
pressing the SET button when the image displayed
below that says the system check has been completed.
v Display a live image.
Press the SET button to display a live image.
If the authentication (login) window is displayed, enter the
user name and password.
When authenticated, a live image will be displayed.
When not authenticated, the authentication (login) window
will be displayed again.
Important:
When using the optional extension unit (WJ-HDE300
series), turn on the power of this unit after turning on the
power of all extension units.
16
CLOCK ADJUSTMENT
It is recommended to check the clock periodically and put
the clock right if it shows the wrong time.
Adjust the clock when displaying a live image.
c Move the cursor to "Time & Date" using the
arrows button (CD), and press the SET but-
ton.
The "Time & Date" menu will be displayed.
zn
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
LIVE
REV
FWD
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
Basic Setup
Date Format
Time Format
Time & Date
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY
12H
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
Time
&
Date
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
User Regist.
User Edit
.
.
:
REPEAT
1
JAN
03
12 00 00
AM
–
+
SET
OFF
12 :00 AM
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
IRIS
I
LISTED
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
9
12
10/0
11
AUTO
I
I
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table
SETUP
SET
13
14
15
16
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
BUSY
xcv cb v
v Move the cursor to "Time Format" using the
arrows button and set the time (Day, Month,
Year, Time) using the jog dial.
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
more.
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the
VGA monitor.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Basic Setup
LIVE
Date Format
Time Format
Time & Date
DD.MMM.YY
12H
I
I
I
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
Time
&
Date
LIVE
Comm
User Regist.
User Edit
:
:
1
.
JAN
.
03
12 00 00
AM
SET
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
OFF
12 :00 AM
AUTO
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
I
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
I
I
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table
SETUP
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
b Move the cursor to "SET" and press the SET
button.
x Move the cursor to "System" using the arrows
The selected date format and the set time will be applied.
button (CDAB) and press the SET button.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Basic Setup
Date Format
Time Format
Time & Date
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY
12H
Time
&
Date
Basic Setup
ADMIN Password
*****
PSD User
ADMIN
Auto Login
Auto Login User
I
I
I
User Regist.
User Edit
Time
&
Date
:
:
1
.
JAN
.
03
12 00 00
AM
SET
OFF
12 :00 AM
User Regist.
User Edit
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
I
ON
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
AUTO
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table
I
I
ADMIN
Auto Logout
Priority
"GO TO LAST" before
Language
Beep(Operation)
Buzzer(Error)
Shutdown Time
Auto Copy
OFF
SETUP
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
Follow the priority.
5s
ENGLISH
ON
2s
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
10s
OFF
n Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
more.
The SETUP MENU will disappear and a live image will be
displayed.
Important:
Recording will stop for around 4 seconds just after set-
ting the clock.
17
SHUTDOWN
To shutdown the unit, do the following.
When recording is being performed, press the REC button
for 2 or more seconds. Recording will stop and the indica-
tor on the REC button will go off.
When playback is being performed, press the STOP button.
Playback will stop and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE
button will go off.
Turn off the power of the unit after confirming that the HDD1
and HDD2 indicators are off.
Important:
• Detach the plug from the outlet if not operating the unit
for a length of time.
• When the unit has not been used for a certain period,
turn on the power of the unit (approximately once a
week), and perform recording/playback to prevent
interferences with functions.
18
RECORDING (Manual Recording)
Do the following to record manually.
Refer to a system administrator about the required settings
for manual recording.
When recording with higher priority than manual recording
is performed, manual recording will not be performed until
this recording finishes.
Refer to the following about the recording mode.
zx
x Stop recording.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
Press the REC button down for around 2 seconds.
The indicator on the button will go off and recording will
stop.
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
Notes:
• The camera selection button will light orange (currently
recording) or blue (currently being recorded and dis-
played on the monitor) to indicate which camera is
being recorded.
• When recording with other recording modes being per-
formed, the indicator on the REC button will not go off
even though the REC button is pressed to stop manual
recording.
z Start recording.
Press the REC button to start recording.
The indicator on the button will light and recording will start.
Images from all the connected cameras will be recorded
with the default setting.
It is possible to record only images displayed on monitor 2
and the VGA monitor by changing the settings.
ꢀ Recording Mode and Priority
There are 4 recording modes as follows.
Recording Mode
Emergency Recording
Event Recording
Manual Recording
Schedule Recording
Description
Priority*1
Start recording manually using an external switch at an emergency event occurrence Highest
Recording will be performed automatically at an event occurrence
Start and stop recording manually
1*2
2*2
3*2
Recording will be performed automatically with a designated start/stop time and date
*1: Priorities on the above table are the default settings. (Emergency recording is the highest priority.)
*2: Priorities for manual recording, schedule recording and event recording can be changed. Refer to a system administrator
about the settings.
19
ꢀ Recording Time
The possible recording durations on the following table are just the average values. (Refer to the important notice below the
table.)
Recording rate for a single camera channel (Recording without audio)
Unit: Hour
Recording Rate [ips]
SFA
19 000
9 500
6 300
4 700
3 800
1 900
1 100
700
SFB
12 700
6 300
4 200
3 100
2 500
1 200
700
FQA
25 400
12 700
8 400
6 300
5 000
2 500
1 400
1 000
600
FQB
19 000
9 500
6 300
4 700
3 800
1 900
1 100
700
NQA
38 100
19 000
12 700
9 500
7 600
3 800
2 200
1 500
900
NQB
25 400
12 700
8 400
6 300
5 000
2 500
1 400
1 000
600
EXA
50 800
25 400
16 900
12 700
10 100
5 000
2 900
2 000
1 200
1 000
800
EXB
38 100
19 000
12 700
9 500
7 600
3 800
2 200
1 500
900
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
1
1.7
2.5
4.2
5
500
400
300
400
300
200
500
300
700
500
700
6.3
8.3
12.5
25
300
200
400
300
600
400
600
200
100
300
200
400
300
600
400
100
100
200
100
300
200
400
300
70
50
100
70
100
100
200
100
50
30
20
50
30
70
50
100
70
Important:
The possible recording durations on the above tables are the average durations under the conditions below. The possible
recording durations varies depending on images to be recorded. Refer to a system administrator for further information.
• Recording on the built-in hard disk (160 GB x 1)
• Recording images from a single camera channel by manual recording
• Resolution: FIELD
• Color Mode: COLOR STD (The color mode setting is available only using a PC via a network.)
• Recording without audio (When recording with audio, disk usage will be at the rate of 79.2 MB per hour.)
20
RECORDING (Emergency Recording)
Record manually using an external switch at an emergency
event occurrence.
For example, install an external switch at the reception
counter, and start recording with it when a suspicious indi-
vidual appears.
• When starting emergency recording while another
recording with a different recording mode (except event
recording) is being performed, the indicator on the REC
button will remain lit and the other recording will resume
after the emergency recording has finished.
Refer to a system administrator about the required settings
for emergency recording.
ꢀ Recording duration of emergency
recording
Recording duration of emergency recording can be set as
follows. Refer to a system administrator for further informa-
tion.
z
Parameter
Recording Duration
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
1 s - 10 s
Record for the selected time (1 - 10 sec-
onds, can be set in 1 second intervals)
Record for 20 seconds
ERROR
SEARCH
ALARM
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
ALARM
RESET
–
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
20 s
30 s
9
12
10/0
11
HDD 1
HDD 2
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
LOGOUT
Record for 30 seconds
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
1 m - 10 m
Record for the selected time (1 -10 min-
utes can be set in 1 minute intervals)
Record for the selected time (20 - 60 min-
utes, can be set in 10 minutes intervals)
Record only while the external switch is
being pressed down
20 m - 60 m
MANUAL
x
z Press the external switch.
The indicator on the REC button will light and recording will
start.
CONTINUE
Record until the ALARM RESET button is
pressed
With the default setting, recording will be performed for 10
seconds.
Emergency recording is the highest priority. Emergency
recording will be performed even when this unit is record-
ing in other recording modes.
x Stop recording.
When the recording duration set in advance has passed,
recording will stop automatically.
With the default setting, recording will stop automatically
after recording for 10 seconds.
When "CONTINUE" is selected for "Recording Time" of
"Emergency REC" on the SETUP MENU (Recording), press
the ALARM RESET button to stop recording.
The indicator on the REC button will go off and recording
will stop.
Important:
• The camera selection button will light orange (currently
recording) or blue (currently being recorded and dis-
played on the monitor) to indicate which camera is
being recorded.
21
PLAYBACK
It is possible to play recorded images without stopping
recording.
The playback images will be displayed on monitor 2 and
the VGA monitor.
x Start playback.
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and the
recorded images of the selected camera will be played.
[WJ-HD316]
First playback after login: The latest recorded image will
be played.
z
c x
With the default setting, playback will start 5 seconds
before the start time of the latest recorded image. The
start time can be selected from the following:
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
BUSY
Refer to a system administrator about the settings.
Other than those above: Playback will start from the end
[WJ-HD309]
point of the recorded image played last time.
z
c x
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
c Stop playback.
Press the STOP button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
playback will be stopped.
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
z Select the camera respective to the recorded
images to be played. (Go to step 2 if not neces-
sary)
Press the desired camera selection button.
The pressed camera selection button will light green or
blue and the respective live images will be displayed.
ꢀ Available functions during playback
Pause
Pressing the PLAY/PAUSE button to pause playback. While pausing,
the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will blink.
PLAY
PAUSE
Pressing this button again will resume playback.
Single frame skip
Rotating the jog dial during pause will skip to the next or previous
frame.
REV
FWD
Rotating the jog dial clockwise will skip to the next frame and rotating
it counterclockwise will skip to the previous frame.
–
+
22
Fast forward/Fast reverse
Hold playback speed
Skip
Rotating the shuttle ring will change the playback speed (1/2x, 1x, 2x,
5x, 10x, 20x) according to rotated degree. When the shuttle ring is
held in the 20x position (rotated to the end) for 5 seconds, the play-
back speed will be 50x. When the shuttle ring is held 5 more seconds
after the playback speed became 50x, the playback speed will be
100x.
Rotating the shuttle ring clockwise will play images at a faster speed
and rotating it counterclockwise will play images in reverse at a faster
speed.
REV
FWD
–
+
To play at normal speed, release the shuttle ring.
Press the SET button while holding the rotated shuttle ring to hold a
desired playback speed. (Playback speed will be held even though
the shuttle ring is released.)
REV
FWD
–
+
To return to the normal playback speed, press the SET button.
+
SET
Rotating the jog dial during playback will skip to the next or previous
recorded image.
REV
FWD
Rotating the jog dial clockwise will skip to the start time of the next
recording and start playback, and rotating it counterclockwise will
skip to the start time of the previous one. (Rotating the jog dial coun-
terclockwise at the point around the start time of the recording will
skip to the start time of two more previous recordings).
If there is no next or previous recorded image, current playback will
continue.
–
+
Play the latest recorded image
Multi-screen display
Press the GO TO LAST button to play the latest recorded image.
PAN/
GOTO
LAST
TILT
It is possible to display recorded images in multi-screen format
(4/7/9/10/13/16 for the WJ-HD316, 4/7/9 for the WJ-HD309).
q Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.
w Press a camera selection button (1 - 6 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 3 for
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired multi-screen.
Camera selection button 1: 4-split screen
Camera selection button 2: 7-split screen
Camera selection button 3: 9-split screen
Camera selection button 4: 16-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
SHIFT
(For the WJ-HD316)
+
+
1
6
SHIFT
SHIFT
SHIFT
(For the WJ-HD309)
+
+
1
3
Camera selection button 5: 10-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
Camera selection button 6: 13-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
e To display recorded images on a single screen, press the SHIFT
button again.
After the SHIFT indicator goes off, press the camera selection but-
ton.
23
Marking
It is possible to play from a marked point. Do the following to mark a
desired point.
Mark
Mark
1. Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.
2. Press the camera selection button 12 (9 for the WJ-HD309) (MARK)
at a desired point to be marked during playback.
Up to 100 points can be marked. When more than 100 points are
marked, the older marked points will be overwritten by the newer
marked points. In this case, the oldest marked point is the first to
be overwritten.
SHIFT
SHIFT
(For the WJ-HD316)
+
+
12
9
(For the WJ-HD309)
When marked while displaying in multi-screen, the same number of
split screens will be counted as marked points. (When a point is
marked while displaying a 16-split screen, 16 points will be marked
simultaneously.)
Text display
It is possible to display text information attached to a recorded image
during playback.
Text display is available only when playing on a single screen.
q Pause playback.
w Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.
e Press the camera selection button 11 (5 for the WJ-HD309) (TEXT).
TEXT
TEXT
SHIFT
SHIFT
(For the WJ-HD316)
+
+
11
5
(For the WJ-HD309)
A - B repeat playback
It is possible to play recorded images between two designated points
repeatedly.
q Designate a start point (A) by pressing the A - B REPEAT button
during playback.
A-B
REPEAT
ZOOM/
FOCUS
The A - B REPEAT indicator will light, and the time of point A will
be displayed.
Blink: During the A-B repeat playback
Light: When designating a start point (A)
Time of point A
To cancel the designated point, press the SETUP/ESC button.
w Designate an end point (B) by pressing the A - B REPEAT button
during playback.
When the start point and the end point are set, the A - B REPEAT
indicator will start blinking.
Playback between point A and B will start and keep playing
repeatedly.
The time of point A and B will be displayed during playback.
Time of point A and B
e Press the A - B REPEAT button during A - B repeat playback to
return to normal playback.
Notes:
• Playback will be paused if the playback time caught up with the recording time (present time) when recording and play-
back are performed simultaneously.
• When playing images recorded at a high recording rate, unsteady playback speed and audio break-up may occur.
24
PLAYBACK IMAGE ON A DESIGNATED DISK
Images from a camera will be recorded on the built-in hard
disk or external recording devices (DVD-RAM drive, DVD-R
[WJ-HD316]
drive or CD-R drive) connected to this unit.
Available disk areas are as follows.
Note: External recording devices can be used as a copy
area for images recorded on the hard disk. It is impos-
sible to record images on the external recording
devices directly.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
BUSY
HDD Normal Recording Area/Event Recording Area:
Disk space for recording on the built-in hard disk
Recorded images by manual recording (refer to page
19) or event recording will be stored in this area.
z
x
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
HDD Copy Area: Disk space for recording on the built-in
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
hard disk
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
Recorded images will be copied in this area (refer to
page 48).
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
Built-in hard disk
z
x
Recording area for
manual recording and
normal schedule
z Press the SHIFT button.
The SHIFT indicator will light.
recording
Normal recording area
x Press the camera selection button 9 (7 for the
Recording area for
event recording and
WJ-HD309) (DISK SELECT).
emergency recording
The DISK SELECT window will be displayed on monitor 2
and the VGA monitor.
Event recording area
Recording area for
copying
DISK SELECT
Copy area
HDD NORMAL/EVENT AREA
HDD COPY AREA
OK
CANCEL
Notes:
• Playback images will be displayed only on monitor 2
and the VGA monitor.
• Playback can be performed during recording.
• When a pre-recording area is created in an optional
extension unit, it is possible to play the images record-
ed on the pre-recording area.
• Disk space size of each recording area differs depend-
ing on the settings.
Refer to a system administrator for further information.
25
n To stop playback, press the STOP button.
n b
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
playback will stop.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
Note: Pressing the PLAY/PAUSE button after stopping play-
back will start playback from the end point of the
recorded image played last time.
BUSY
c cv cv
c Select a disk to be played using the jog dial
and move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows
button. Press the SET button to determine the
selection.
DISK SELECT
HDD NORMAL/EVENT AREA
HDD COPY AREA
OK
CANCEL
The recording event list window will be displayed. (Refer to
page 28 for further information.)
To close the DISK SELECT window, move the cursor to
select "CANCEL" and press the SET button.
Important:
In the following cases, the recording event list window will
not be displayed even when you move the cursor to "OK"
and press the SET button after selecting "HDD COPY
AREA":
• When another user has selected the HDD copy area
• When copying is being performed manually in the HDD
copy area using a PC via a network
v Rotate the jog dial to select a desired recorded
image to be played, and press the SET button
to determine the selection.
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
b Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to play the
selected recorded image.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and play-
back will start.
26
PLAYBACK FROM A DESIGNATED TIME AND DATE
It is possible to play recorded images from a designated
c Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and start
playback from the entered time and date.
time and date without stopping recording.
Playback images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the
VGA monitor.
If there is no recorded image after the entered time:
When there are images recorded after the entered time, the
oldest recorded image after the entered time will be played.
When there are no images recorded after the entered time,
the newest recorded image before the entered time will be
played.
v c
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
v Press the STOP button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
z
x
x
stop playback.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the
time and date designation window is dis-
played.
The time and date designation window will be displayed on
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor.
START
:
:
1
JAN
12
00
00 AM
03
.
.
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
x Enter the start time using the jog dial and the
arrows button.
Select the time and date using the jog dial. To move the
cursor, use the arrows button (AB).
START
:
:
2
FEB
12
00
00 AM
04
.
.
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
27
SEARCH AND PLAY
There are 3 ways to search for a recorded image and play it.
• Search for a recording event and play it (Recording event search)
• Search for a motion detected time and date from the recorded images and play it (VMD search)
• Search for a marked point and play it (Marking search)
Note: Playback images will be displayed on a single screen on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. To play in a multi-screen,
switch to a multi-screen after starting playback.
I Search for a Recording Event and Play it back (Recording Event
Search)
Display a list or a thumbnail of recording events, and select the desired recording event from them to play it.
It is possible to search using the following filters:
Search Filters
TIME & DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
Search for only images recorded in the entered time range.
Search for only recorded images from the selected camera channel.
Search for only images recorded in the selected recording mode.
It is possible to search for images recorded in the following recording modes:
EMERGENCY: Emergency recording (Refer to page 21.)
VMD:
TERMINAL:
Event recording performed when motion was detected (Refer to page 32.)
Event recording performed when a terminal alarm was detected.
COMMAND: Event recording performed when a command alarm was detected.
VIDEO LOSS: Event recording performed when video loss occurred.
MANUAL:
Manual recording (Refer to page 19.)
SCHEDULE: Schedule recording (Refer to page 105.)
Search for only images recorded with text information
TEXT
ꢀ Recording Event List Window
Searching filter buttons
Filter cancel button
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
Recording event
Text information
Camera Channel
Time and date
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
Time range of listed data
Number of listed data
Searching information
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
28
Search filter buttons:
Filter cancel button:
Time and date:
Selects the search filter
Cancels the selected search filter and lists all recording events
<When searched by recording event>
The time when recording started will be displayed.
<When searched by VMD>
The time when motion was detected will be displayed.
<When searched by marked point>
The time when the point was marked will be displayed.
The camera channel of the recorded image will be displayed. The recorded image of
the displayed camera channel will be played on a single screen.
The recording mode will be displayed.
The first several characters of text information will be displayed if the image has text
information.
Camera channel:
Recording event:
Text information:
Time range of the listed data:
Number of the listed data:
Search information:
The time range of the listed data will be displayed.
The number of the listed data will be displayed.
The search filter will be displayed. (A filter of the currently displayed list will be dis-
played in orange.)
ꢀ Recording Event Thumbnail Window
Time and date
Camera channel/Recording event
Number of listed data
Time and date:
<When searched by recording event>
The time when recording started will be displayed.
<When searched by VMD>
The time when motion was detected will be displayed.
<When searched by marked point>
The time when the point was marked will be displayed.
Camera channel/Recording event: The camera channel of the recorded image will be displayed. The recorded image of
the displayed camera channel will be played on a single screen. The recording mode
also will be displayed.
Number of the listed data:
The number of the listed data will be displayed.
Note: Some images displayed in the thumbnail window may not match with their respective displayed recorded time due to
playing of compressed recorded images.
29
x Use the arrows button (AB) to select a search
filter (TIME & DATE, CAMERA, EVENT, TEXT),
and press the SET button.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
13
14
15
16
BUSY
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
z z
x
x
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the
recording event list window is displayed.
When a search filter is selected, the respective search filter
window will be displayed.
Select "UNLOCK FILTER" and press the SET button to can-
cel the selected filter.
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
Refer to page 28 about search filters.
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
The recording event list window will be displayed on moni-
tor 2 and the VGA monitor.
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.
To search using a search filter, go to step 4.
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
<List window>
<Thumbnail window>
30
Filter recording events by the recording event
b
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REC EVENT FILTERING
EMERGENCY OFF
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
VMD
ON
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
TERMINAL ON
COMMAND ON
VIDEO LOSS ON
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
MANUAL
SCHEDULE
ON
ON
SET : [ SET ]
CANCEL : [ ESC ]
c
c
c
v
Move the cursor to select the recording event (refer to page
28) using the arrows button (CD) and rotate the jog dial to
ON.
c Filter recording events.
Filter recording events by time and date
Press the SET button to determine the selection.
The recording events of the selected filter will be listed.
TIME&DATE FILTERING
I
START
Filter recording events by text information
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM
AM
1
END
1
JAN
JAN
03
03
00
0
00
00
TEXT FILTERING
WITHOUT TEXT
SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]
Move the cursor using the arrows button and rotate the jog
dial to enter the time and date.
Press the SET button to determine the entered time and
date.
SET : [ SET ]
CANCEL : [ ESC ]
The recording event in the entered time range will be listed
and displayed.
Rotate the jog dial to select OFF, WITH TEXT or WITHOUT
TEXT.
Press the SET button to determine the selection.
The recording events filtered by the selected filter will be
listed.
Filter recording events by camera channel
CAMERA FILTERING
CAMERA
v Rotate the jog dial to select the recording event
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
to be played.
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
SET : [ SET ]
CANCEL : [ ESC ]
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
Select camera channel numbers (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316,
1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309) using the arrows button to apply fil-
tering. It is possible to select camera channels using the
camera selection buttons [1] - [16] for the WJ-HD316 ([1] -
[9] for the WJ-HD309).
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM TOTAL
12345
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
The selected camera channels will turn white.
Press the SET button to determine the selection of camera
channel numbers.
It is possible to turn the page by rotating the shuttle ring.
The recording events of the selected camera channels will
be listed.
b Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE
button will light and playback of the selected recording
event will start.
Note: When operating the system controller, select a cam-
era channel using the numeric keypad. In this case, it is
impossible to select 10 CH to 16 CH.
Note: When the LISTED indicator is lit, only listed recording
events are available to be played. Press the LISTED
button during playback to make all recording events
available to be played.
31
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the
n
VMD search list is displayed.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
VMD SEARCH
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
TIME&DATE
CAM
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
2
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
12345
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
n To stop playback, press the STOP button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
playback will be stopped.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
The result list of the VMD search will be displayed on moni-
tor 2 and the VGA monitor.
(The list in the displayed window is of the results of the pre-
vious search.)
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.
Important:
In the recording event list, the start time of recording
will be displayed.
When events occurred successively, the contents of the
event log and the recording event list will not always
match since the unit continues to record the first occur-
ring event.
VMD SEARCH
TIME&DATE
CAM
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
12345
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
<List window>
I Search for a motion detected
time and date from the recorded
images and play it (VMD search)
Search for a motion detected time and date from all the
images recorded in all the recording modes, and display a
list or a thumbnail of the results.
Select a time and date displayed on the result list or thumb-
nail to play it.
It is possible to filter by camera channel, time and date,
detection area or search mode, to list the time and date of
events that were recorded when motion was detected.
z
<Thumbnail window>
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
2
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
32
The motion detection area setup window will be displayed.
To search using the same conditions as the previous
search, press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
Go to step 12 when the VMD search is performed and a list
of the results is displayed after the PLAY/PAUSE button is
pressed.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
Note: If no image was recorded in the time range set in
step 3, the motion detection area setup window will not
be displayed when the SET button is pressed.
cn xvn cb
x Press the SET button.
b Rotate the jog dial to select "SETUP AREA" on
the status bar.
SELECT CAMERA & DATE
I
CAMERA
CAM1
START
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM
AM
1
END
1
JAN
JAN
03
03
12
12
00
00
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]
The VMD search window will be displayed.
Enter a camera channel number and time range on the
VMD search window for the VMD search.
To search using the same conditions as the previous
search, press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
Note: It is possible to set all displayed areas as motion
detection areas by pressing the SET button after select-
ing "ALL AREAS".
Go to step 12 when the VMD search is performed and a list
of the results is displayed after the PLAY/PAUSE button is
pressed.
n Move the cross cursor using the arrows button
to a point to be determined as the start point of
the motion detection area.
c Move the cursor using the arrows button and
rotate the jog dial to enter the camera channel
number and time range for the VMD search.
SELECT CAMERA & DATE
I
CAMERA
CAM1
START
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM
AM
1
END
1
JAN
JAN
03
03
12
12
00
00
Press the SET button to determine the selected point as the
start point of the motion detection area.
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]
v Press the SET button.
33
⁄ Select the sensitivity using the arrows button
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
(DC) from the following.
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
OFF: Motion will not be detected
LOW: Low sensitivity
MID: Standard sensitivity
HIGH: High sensitivity
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
m.⁄
m
,
⁄
⁄ Rotate the jog dial to select "EXIT" on the sta-
tus bar to exit from the motion detection area
setup window.
m Move the cross cursor using the arrows button
to a point to be determined as the end point of
the motion detection area.
Press the SET button to determine the selected point as the
end point of the motion detection area.
It is possible to set up to 4 motion detection areas by
repeating steps 6 and 7.
, Rotate the jog dial to select "SENSITIVITY" on
the status bar.
Note: Depending on the position of the set detection areas,
the sensitivity indications of the detection areas may be
displayed overlapping each other.
. Move the cross cursor to the motion detection
area to apply the sensitivity using the arrows
button (AB).
34
⁄ Press the SET button or the PLAY/PAUSE but-
ton to start searching and display the results
of the VMD search.
⁄ ⁄⁄
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
VMD SEARCH
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
TIME&DATE
CAM
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
⁄
⁄⁄ ⁄⁄
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
12345
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
⁄ Move the cursor to select a detection mode
using the arrow buttons and rotate the jog dial
to check the radio button next to the selected
detection mode. Press the SET button to deter-
mine the selection.
Up to 200 results will be displayed. (When 200 results are
listed, searching will stop.)
Notes:
• It may take some time until the search results are dis-
played.
VMD SEARCH
I
ANY AREA
• It is possible to stop searching by pressing the STOP
button.
MASKING DURATION
24h
VECTOR
A
20s
DURATION
20s
B
20s
C
C
20s
20s
D
D
A
B
20s
20s
⁄ Rotate the jog dial to select a result to be dis-
played.
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]
VMD SEARCH
Refer to page 36 for further information about each of the
detection modes.
TIME&DATE
CAM
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
<ANY AREA mode>
Move the cursor to the parameter box using the arrows but-
ton (C) to select a masking duration from the following.
1 s/1 m/1 h/24 h
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
12345
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
<VECTOR mode>
It is possible to turn the page by rotating the shuttle ring.
Move the cursor to an area for the settings of VECTOR
using the arrows button (C) and rotate the jog dial to select
an area. Move the cursor to the parameter box of the
selected area using the arrows button (B) to select an
interval time for an object moving between each area from
the following.
⁄ Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to start play-
back.
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE
button will light and playback of the selected recording will
start.
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m
Note: It is possible to skip from the playback point to the
listed time (motion detected time) by rotating the jog
dial when the LISTED indicator is lit.
<DURATION>
Move the cursor to the parameter box of each area using
the arrows button (B) and rotate the jog dial to select a
moving duration for an object in each area from the follow-
ing.
To return to normal playback, press the LISTED button.
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m
⁄ Press the STOP button to stop playback.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
playback will be stopped.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
35
Any motion will be detected anywhere in the A, B, C, D
areas.
I To delete the motion detection
area
Note: In the ANY AREA mode, it is possible to set the
masking duration. When the masking duration is set,
motion will be ignored for a certain period (set duration
as the masking duration) in the same area. It is conve-
nient to set the masking duration to make the subject
period shorter in case it is necessary to search an
extended time range or when searching through many
results.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
<VECTOR mode>
zx
x
It will be subject to listing if an object moves within the set
time to the other detection areas in the set order.
The following is an example.
z Rotate the jog dial to select "DELETE AREA"
on the status bar.
10 s
A
C
B
D
10 s
Motion is detected in area B within 10 seconds after being
detected in area A.
Motion is detected in area C within 20 seconds after being
detected in area B.
Note: To delete all the motion detection areas, select
"DELETE ALL AREA" and press the SET button.
Motion is detected in area D within 10 seconds after being
detected in area C.
When all of the above have occurred, an event action will
be performed.
x Move the cursor to the motion detection area
to be deleted using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
The selected area will be deleted.
<DURATION mode>
It will be subject to listing if an object keeps moving for the
set period in the detection area. For example, in case of the
following settings; 10 sec. for areas A and B, 20 sec. for
area C and 30 sec. for area D:
An event action will be performed when an object keeps
moving longer than the set period in the specified detection
area.
ꢀ Detection Mode
Set how to detect motion in the set motion detection area.
There are 3 detection modes as follows:
Important:
It is impossible to set two or more detection modes
simultaneously.
A
C
B
D
<ANY AREA mode>
It will be subject to listing if "motion" is detected in any of
the set motion detection areas.
A
C
B
D
Important:
• When images to be searched are recorded with a low
recording rate, the DURATION mode may not work cor-
rectly.
• It may take some time to search according to the con-
tents of the recorded images.
36
To delete all displayed marking lists, press the camera
selection buttons [1] and [2] simultaneously for 2 seconds
or more when displaying the marking list window.
I Search for a marked point and
play from that point (Marking
search)
Display the recording time of the recorded images with a
marked point in a list or a thumbnail and select the desired
recording time to play. Refer to page 24 for further informa-
tion about marking.
x Rotate the jog dial or the shuttle ring to select
the desired marked time.
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
TEXT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
v c z
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
c Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.
z
x x
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE
button will light, and playback of a recorded image from the
selected marked time will start.
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the
Notes:
marking list window is displayed.
• It is possible to skip from the playback point to the list-
ed time (marked time) by rotating the jog dial when the
LISTED indicator is lit.
To return to normal playback, press the LISTED button.
• It is possible that some recorded images with marked
points may have been deleted by overwrite recording
or the delete function.
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
TEXT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
v Press the STOP button.
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and
playback will be stopped.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
The result list of the marking search will be displayed on
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor.
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
TEXT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
37
MONITOR LIVE IMAGES
It is possible to display live images on a single screen or a
multi-screen.
I Electronic Zoom
When displaying a single screen, zooming in on the dis-
played image is possible.
Electronic zoom is available only on the selected monitor.
When the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 indicator is lit (the moni-
tor 1 is selected), electronic zoom works only on monitor 1.
On a single sequential display (It is also possible that dis-
played images from cameras will be switched automatical-
ly)
I Displaying Live Images on a
[WJ-HD316]
Single Screen
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
[WJ-HD316]
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
z
x
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
3
7
4
8
PRESET
/AUTO
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
2
SET
13
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
BUSY
PAN/TILT
SLOW
6
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
z x
2
SET
13
BUSY
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
[WJ-HD309]
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
z
x
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
MARK
LOGOUT
REV
FWD
R
R
IRIS
LISTED
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
PRESET
/AUTO
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
2
SET
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
BUSY
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
z
x
BUSY
z Press the SHIFT button when monitoring live
images on a single screen.
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to
The SHIFT indicator will light.
select the monitor.
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.
When monitor 2 or the VGA monitor is selected, the indica-
tor will not light.
x Press the EL-ZOOM button to enlarge the dis-
played image.
The displayed image will be displayed with x2 zoomed
size.
x Press a camera selection button
(1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for the WJ-
HD309) to select a camera.
Zooming level will change each time the EL-ZOOM button
is pressed.
x2 → x4 → OFF
Live images from the selected camera will be displayed
and the respective camera selection button will light green
or blue.
When monitor 2 is selected, live images will be displayed
on the VGA monitor.
Notes:
• When an image is zoomed in on (x2 or x4), it is possible
to move the zoomed image using the arrows button.
• When any indicator of PAN/TILT, ZOOM/FOCUS, IRIS,
PRESET/AUTO is lit, it is impossible to use the EL-
ZOOM function.
38
The camera selection buttons respective to the live images
displayed on a multi-screen will light green or blue.
I Displaying on a Multi-screen
It is possible to display images on a multi-screen (4, 7, 9,
10, 13, 16 for the WJ-HD316, 4, 7, 9 for the WJ-HD309).
[WJ-HD316]
z
c
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
When monitor 2 is selected in step 1, live images will also
be displayed on the selected multi-screen on the VGA mon-
itor.
2
SET
13
BUSY
x
To display on a single screen
[WJ-HD309]
Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will go off.
Press any of the camera selection buttons.
Live images will be displayed on a single screen.
z
c
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
When displaying on a 4-split screen
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
Each time the camera selection button 4 is pressed, the
displayed camera channels will be changed as follows:
WJ-HD316: 1-4 CH – 5-8 CH – 9-12 CH – 13-16 CH
WJ-HD309: 1-4 CH – 5-8 CH – 9 CH
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
x
When displaying on a 9-split screen
Each time the camera selection button 9 is pressed, the
displayed camera channels will be changed as follows:
Only for the WJ-HD316: 1-9 CH – 10-16 CH
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to
select the monitor.
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.
When monitor 2 is selected, the indicator will not light.
x Press the SHIFT button.
The SHIFT indicator will light.
c Press a camera selection button 1 - 6 (1 - 3 for
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired multi-
screen.
Camera selection button 1: 4-split screen
Camera selection button 2: 7-split screen
Camera selection button 3: 9-split screen
Camera selection button 4: 16-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
Camera selection button 5: 10-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
Camera selection button 6: 13-split screen (Only for the WJ-
HD316)
39
I Sequential Display
Displayed images from cameras will be switched automati-
cally.
Camera images will be displayed sequentially according to
the settings performed in advance.
[WJ-HD316]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
BUSY
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to
select the monitor.
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.
When monitor 2 is selected, the indicator will not light.
x Press the SHIFT button.
The SHIFT indicator will light.
c Press the SEQ button.
The camera selection button respective to the displayed
image will light green.
To stop sequential display, press the SEQ button.
When trying to display on a single screen or multi-screen
during the sequential display, the sequential display will be
stopped.
When monitor 2 is selected in step 1, the sequential display
will also start on the VGA monitor.
40
CONTROL CAMERAS
When displaying live images, the following camera controls
are possible.
• Panning/tilting: Moves a camera horizontally/vertically.
I Zoom
Zooms in/out on images. Depending on models of the con-
nected cameras, the image size for the respective zooming
level may be different. For further information, refer to the
operating instruction for the camera.
• Zooming:
• Focus:
Zooms in/out on images.
Adjusts the focus.
• Iris:
• Preset action:
Adjusts the iris of the lens.
Moves a camera to the preset position
registered in advance.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
• Auto function:
Moves a camera with an auto function
set in advance.
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
Notes:
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
• Controlling cameras is possible only when displaying
images on a single screen.
• Depending on models of the connected cameras, it
may be impossible to control the camera or some func-
tions may not be available.
z
x
c
• When a user with higher priority is controlling the select-
ed camera, it may be impossible to control the camera.
Refer to page 66 for further information about priority.
• Refer to page 127 for descriptions of how to display
and perform the settings with the settings menu of the
camera from this unit.
z Press the ZOOM/FOCUS button.
The ZOOM/FOCUS indicator will light.
x Use the arrows button (CD) to zoom in on or
out of the displayed image.
Press the arrows button downward (C) to zoom out and
upward (D) to zoom in.
I Panning/Tilting
Moves a camera horizontally/vertically.
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)
respective to the controlled camera channel to
quit the zooming operation.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
2
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
I Focus
Adjusts the focus. The auto focus function is available.
c
zx x
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
z Press the PAN/TILT button.
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
The PAN/TILT indicator will light.
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
x Use the arrows button to adjust the vertical or
horizontal position.
z
x x
c
Camera will move slowly by pressing the arrows button
while holding the PAN/TILT SLOW button down.
z Press the FOCUS button.
The ZOOM/FOCUS indicator will light.
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)
respective to the controlled camera channel to
quit the panning/tilting operation.
41
x Use the arrows button (AB) to adjust the
I Preset Action
Moves a camera to the preset position registered in
focus.
Press the arrows button (A) to shift the focus farther.
Press the arrows button (B) to shift the focus nearer.
Auto focus is available by pressing the SET button.
advance.
Important:
• When using a camera of the WV-CS650 (WV-CSR650)
series or the WV-CS600 (WV-CSR600) series, register
preset positions using the settings menu of the camera.
• When the monitor 1 is selected, it is impossible to regis-
ter preset positions and move a camera to a preset
position by performing the following steps.
In this case, perform the settings using the setup menu
of camera.
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)
respective to the controlled camera channel to
quit the focusing operation.
I Iris
Adjusts the iris of the lens.
ꢀ Register Preset Positions of Cameras
Up to 64 preset positions can be registered.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
[WJ-HD316]
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
REV
FWD
R
R
IRIS
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
1
PRESET
/AUTO
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
LOGOUT
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
SET
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
13
14
15
16
REPEAT
BUSY
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
BUSY
z
x x
c
x
z
z Press the IRIS button.
The IRIS indicator will light.
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
x Use the arrows button (AB) to adjust the iris.
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
Press the arrows button (A) to close the iris.
Press the arrows button (B) to open the iris.
To reset the set iris, press the SET button.
PRESET
/AUTO
SET
BUSY
x
z
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)
respective to the controlled camera channel to
quit the iris operation.
z Press the PAN/TILT button and move the cam-
era to a desired position to be registered as a
preset position.
x Press the SET button. The REGISTRATION
PRESET POSITION window will be displayed.
REGISTRATION PRESET POSITION
32
PRESET NUMBER
OK
CANCEL
42
[WJ-HD316]
I Move a camera to the preset
position
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
[WJ-HD316]
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
SET
13
REV
FWD
BUSY
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
c
v v
c
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
SET
13
[WJ-HD309]
BUSY
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
z
c
c
x
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
[WJ-HD309]
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
SET
REV
FWD
BUSY
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
c
v v
c
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
SET
BUSY
c Press a camera selection button
([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for
the WJ-HD309) to register a preset position
number.
z
c
c
x
The pressed button number will be registered as a preset
position number.
The jog dial also can be used to select a preset position
number by rotating it.
z Press the PRESET/AUTO button.
The PRESET/AUTO indicator will light and the PRESET/
AUTO PAN window will be displayed.
Up to 64 can be registered as preset position numbers.
x Press a camera selection button
([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired preset posi-
tion.
v Select "OK" using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
The adjusted camera position (currently displayed on the
monitor) will be registered as a preset position with the
selected preset position number.
To cancel the selected preset position, select "CANCEL"
using the arrows button and press the SET button. The set-
ting will be canceled and the REGISTRATION PRESET
POSITION window will be closed.
Pressing the camera selection button [10/0] ([0] for the WJ-
HD309) moves a camera to the home position.
The jog dial can also be used to select a preset position
number by rotating it.
PRESET / AUTO PAN
PRESET
32
PRESET NUMBER
AUTO PAN
OK
CANCEL
c Select "OK" using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
The PRESET/AUTO PAN window will be closed and the
camera will move to the selected preset position.
When selecting "CANCEL" using the arrows button and
press the SET button, the PRESET/AUTO PAN window will
be closed.
43
Note: To move the camera to another registered preset
position, press the SET button after selecting a desired
preset position number in step 2. The PRESET/AUTO
PAN window will not close and it is possible to select
another preset number.
Note: Refer to the operating instructions of the camera for
further information about the auto function of the cam-
era in use.
I Auto Function (Auto Pan, etc)
Moves a camera with an auto function set in advance.
Important:
When monitor 1 is selected, it is impossible to move a
camera with an auto function by performing the follow-
ing steps.
In this case, perform the settings using the setup menu
of camera.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
c
x
z
xc
z Press the PRESET/AUTO button.
The PRESET/AUTO indicator will light and the PRESET/
AUTO PAN window will be displayed.
x Move the cursor to "AUTO PAN" using the
arrows button and check the radio button next
to "AUTO PAN" using the jog dial.
PRESET / AUTO PAN
PRESET
32
PRESET NUMBER
AUTO PAN
OK
CANCEL
c Select "OK" using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
The PRESET/AUTO PAN window will be closed and auto
function will start.
During auto function, it is impossible to register a preset
position. To close the PRESET/AUTO PAN window, select
"CANCEL" using the arrows button and press the SET but-
ton. The setting will be canceled and the PRESET/AUTO
PAN window will be closed.
44
ABOUT THE EVENT FUNCTION
The event action will be performed when the following
events occur.
• Motion detection: When motion is detected by the
motion detection function (see below), this is stated as
an event of motion detection.
ꢀ Activity Detection Mode (ACT DET)
This mode records images in the place where an event
occurred without announcing it.
• Video Loss: When a video signal supply is stopped
because of a cable disconnection or malfunction of a
camera, this is stated as an event of video loss.
• Terminal alarm: When a signal is supplied from an
external device such as a door sensor to the ALARM
terminal, this is stated as an event of the terminal alarm.
• Command alarm: When a command alarm is supplied
from a PC connected to the SERIAL connector on the
rear panel of this unit, this is stated as an event of the
command alarm.
Activity Detection
Event Action
Start recording
Alarm Mode
Mode
ꢁ
ꢁ
ꢁ
Displays event information
on the monitor.
–
ꢁ
ꢁ
Blinks the alarm indicator.
Sounds the buzzer.
–
–
* Switches from a displayed
image to the image from
the location of the alarm
occurrence.
ꢁ
–
About the Motion Detection Function (VMD)
An alarm signal will be supplied when motion (luminance
transition) is detected in a designated area. It is possible to
save images recorded in the place where motion is detect-
ed, or send e-mails when motion is detected.
Refer to a system administrator for further information about
the required settings for the motion detection function such
as the settings of the detection area.
* Moves a camera to the
preset position.
ꢁ
ꢁ
ꢁ
* Announces an event
occurrence by sending e-
mails.
–
* Announces an event
occurrence by the
PS·Data/Serial (RS232C)
commands.
ꢁ
ꢁ
–
Supplies a signal from the
ALARM connector or the
ALARM/CONTROL connec-
tor on the rear panel of this
unit (Alarm signal output).
I Action at an event occurrence
The event action will be performed according to the set-
tings when an event occurs.
ꢁ
ꢁ
ꢁ
Records the event log.
There are 2 event action modes for the alarm mode
(ALARM) and the activity detection mode (ACT DET) for
each event type. The event action will be different accord-
ing to the event action mode set.
When an event of the alarm mode (ALARM) occurs, this unit
activates the alarm action.
* Transmits images to an
FTP server
–
ꢁ : Applicable
– : Not applicable
* : Available only when using a PC via a network (Refer to
the Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for further informa-
tion.)
About the event action mode
ꢀ Alarm Mode (ALARM)
This mode announces an event occurrence outside. Action
taken in the alarm mode is referred to as the alarm action.
45
ꢀ Displays the event information in the alarm
display area on monitor 1 and the camera
title display area on monitor 2
I Alarm Function
ꢀ Blinks the ALARM indicator on the front
panel
TIMER
ERROR
ALARM
ALARM
SUSPEND
ALARM
RESET
HDD 1
HDD 2
OPERATE
<Monitor 1>
ꢀ Switches from the images displayed on
monitor 1 and monitor 2 to the images from
the location of the alarm occurrence (on a
single screen)
<Monitor 2>
ꢀ Sounds the buzzer
Contact a system administrator about sounding duration.
ꢀ Announces an event occurrence to the con-
nected system device (Alarm Output)
Sends
a
signal to the device connected to the
ALARM/CONTROL connector, and the connected device
such as a buzzer will be activated.
ꢀ Starts recording automatically
Starts recording the image from the location of the event
occurrence automatically.
ꢀ Moves a camera to the preset position
A camera will move to the preset position registered in
advance.
ꢀ Announces an event occurrence by sending
e-mails
E-mails will be sent to addresses registered in advance.
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) on the
provided CD-ROM.
46
I Cancel the Alarm Action
I Suspend the Alarm Actions
It is possible to suspend (deactivate temporarily) the alarm
When an alarm has occurred, this unit will start the alarm
action according to the selected alarm action mode.
To cancel the alarm action, press the ALARM RESET but-
ton.
When "ON" is selected for "Alarm Auto Reset" (on the "Alarm
Setup" menu of "Event"), the following will be performed
automatically even if the alarm action is not canceled by
pressing the ALARM RESET button on the front panel.
actions even when an event has occurred.
This function will be useful when it is necessary not to acti-
vate the alarm actions for a certain period, such as when
configuring the system. However, images and event logs
will be recorded even when alarm actions are suspended.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FW
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
• The ALARM indicator will stop blinking and light steadi-
ly
ERROR
SEARCH
M
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
ALARM
RESET
D
–
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
• The displayed alarm information will disappear
• The buzzer will stop beeping
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
HDD 1
HDD 2
PRESET
/AUTO
E
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
zx
zx
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
ERROR
ALARM
A
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
ALARM
SUSPEND
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
HDD 1
HDD 2
OPERATE
13
ꢀ To suspend (deactivate temporarily)
the alarm actions
z
z Press both the ALARM RESET button and the
SET button at the same time.
The ALARM SUSPEND indicator will light.
z Press the ALARM RESET button to cancel the
alarm actions.
The ALARM indicator will go off.
ꢀ To stop suspending the alarm
actions
x Press both the ALARM RESET button and the
SET button at the same time again.
The ALARM SUSPEND indicator will go off.
Note: When an external switch is connected to the
ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel, it is
possible to suspend the alarm actions using the exter-
nal switch.
In this case, the alarm actions will be suspended when
the external switch is on.
To stop suspending the alarm actions, set the external
switch to off.
47
COPYING (Duplicate)
It is possible to copy (duplicate) manually the images
recorded on the disk area selected with the DISK SELECT
window (page 25) to the HDD copy area or the external
recording device (DVD-RAM disk, DVD-R disk, CD-R disk)
connected to the unit.
z Press the SHIFT button.
The SHIFT indicator will light.
To copy recorded images during playback, pause the play-
back temporarily.
It is recommended to make back-up copies on a regular
basis for unexpected situations such as malfunction of the
hard disk.
x Press the COPY button.
Manual copy is available during the following.
• While displaying live images
DATA COPY
CAMERA
• While pausing playback of recorded images
• When displaying a search window (Recording event list
window, VMD search list window, Marking list window)
(Manual copy is not available when a thumbnail window
is displayed.)
1
9
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
PERIOD
.
.
.
.
:
1
1
JAN
JAN
03
03
12
00
05
AM
AM
:
12
COPY DRIVE
HDD COPY AREA
COPY 1
OK
COPY 2
CANCEL
Notes:
• The auto copy function is available for copying record-
ed images to the DVD-RAM disk automatically. When
the auto copy function is enabled, manual copy is not
available. Refer to a system administrator for further
information about the auto copy function.
• To copy during playback of recorded images, pause
the playback temporarily.
• To copy recorded images on the DVD-RAM disk, for-
matting (initializing) the DVD-RAM disk is required in
advance. Refer to page 52 for the descriptions of how
to format DVD-RAM disks.
• Copy time may differ depending on the size of the
recorded image. It may take longer to copy images
recorded in higher quality and resolution even when
selecting the same number of cameras and designating
the same recording duration.
The DATA COPY window will be displayed on monitor 2
and the VGA monitor.
The DATA COPY window will not be displayed when a
thumbnail window is displayed.
In this case, display a list window using the arrows button
(CD).
Notes:
• When the auto copy function is enabled, the DATA
COPY window will not be displayed.
• The copy cancel window will be displayed if the user
who started manual copy presses the COPY button dur-
ing the manual copy. (It is impossible to stop manual
copy performed by other users.)
c Perform the settings for data copy (camera
channel, time range, the disk on which images
are to be copied). Move the cursor to each set-
ting item using the arrows button and select a
parameter by rotating the jog dial.
[WJ-HD316]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
Note: Time range to be set for "PERIOD" should be 30 min-
2
SET
13
BUSY
utes or less to copy images for one attempt.
z
x
c
c
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
z
x
c
c
48
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
v v
v Select the "OK" button using the arrows button
and press the SET button.
The DATA COPY window will be closed and data copy will
start.
The copy icon will be displayed on the task bar during
copying.
To close the DATA COPY window, select "CANCEL" using
the arrows button and press the SET button. The setting will
be canceled and the DATA COPY window will be closed.
Copy icon
In the following cases, copying will not start even when you
move the cursor to "OK" and press the SET button:
• When another user has selected the desired copy drive
• When copying is being performed manually
Important:
• To eject the disk, do the following while live images are
displayed.
<To eject the disk of COPY1>
Confirm the SHIFT indicator is lit. Then, press the COPY
button and [1] simultaneously for 2 seconds or more.
<To eject the disk of COPY2>
Confirm the SHIFT indicator is lit. Then, press the COPY
button and [2] simultaneously for 2 seconds or more.
• Copying will be performed in the following order:
Viewer Software → Images → Audio
Depending on the set time range for "PERIOD", some of
images and audio may not be copied.
• Use the viewer software to play the copied images.
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) for
descriptions of how to play the copied images.
49
DELETE DATA ON THE DISK
Perform the settings for the built-in hard disk of the unit, the
optional extension unit and the DVD-RAM disk. These are
the descriptions of how to delete recorded images on the
hard disk and how to format a DVD-RAM disk.
Refer to a system administrator for further information about
the other disks.
x Move the cursor to "Maintenance" using the
arrows button (CDAB) and press the SET
button.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
I Deletion of recorded images
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
saved on the hard disk manually
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
Delete recorded images saved in the normal area or the
event area of the built-in hard disk or the optional extension
unit manually.
By setting a time and date, images in the normal record
area of the hard disk recorded before the set time and date
will be deleted.
c Move the cursor to "Data Delete" using the
arrows button (CD).
The "Data Delete" menu will be displayed.
Manually delete unwanted images on the hard disk.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Important:
LIVE
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
It is impossible to recover the deleted images.
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
DELETE
.
03
Note: It is possible to delete recorded images automatically
when the set days have passed from the day the image
was recorded (Auto Delete). Refer to a system adminis-
trator for further information.
COPY1
COPY2
FORMAT
FORMAT
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
z
v Press the SET button.
The cursor will be displayed on the "Data Delete" menu.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
LISTED
SETUP MENU
9
12
10/0
11
LIVE
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
2
SET
13
14
15
16
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
BUSY
Disk Info
.
.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
.
03
DELETE
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
v
xc
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
more.
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the
VGA monitor.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
50
m
, Press the SET button for 2 seconds or more.
The SETUP MENU will be closed and the live images will be
displayed.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
2
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
n, b
bn
b Move the cursor to "Manual Delete for Normal
Recording Area" or "Manual Delete for Event
Recording Area" using the arrows button, and
set time and date using the jog dial.
The images recorded the day before the set time and date
will be subject to be deleted.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
DELETE
.
03
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
n Move the cursor to "DELETE" using the arrows
button and press the SET button.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
.
03
DELETE
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
m Select "OK" using the arrows button and press
the SETUP/ESC button.
Normal recording area is going
to be erased.
OK
CANCEL
To cancel delete, select "CANCEL".
51
FORMAT (INITIALIZE) A DVD-RAM DISK
To copy (duplicate) recorded images onto the DVD-RAM
disk, formatting (initializing) the DVD-RAM disk is required
in advance.
c Select "Data Delete" using the arrows button
(CD).
To delete images recorded on the DVD-RAM disk, format-
ting (initialization) of the DVD-RAM disk is also required.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
Important:
I
I
.
JAN
.
03
DELETE
All data on the disk will be deleted if formatted (initial-
ized). It is impossible to recover the deleted images.
COPY1
COPY2
FORMAT
FORMAT
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
z
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
v Press the SET button.
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
The cursor will be displayed on the "Data Delete" menu.
9
12
10/0
11
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
2
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
.
xcb xv
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
DELETE
.
03
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
Event Log
Error Log
z Press the ESC/SETUP button for 2 seconds or
Access Log
more.
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the
VGA monitor.
b Select either"COPY1" or "COPY2" (port to
which the DVD-RAM is connected) for "Disc
Format of DVD" using the arrows button.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Auto Delete
I
I
OFF
Event Log
Error Log
REC Rate
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
SUPER FINE
FINE
Disk Info
.
.
03
03
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
I
I
.
JAN
DELETE
.
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
x Select "Maintenance" using the arrows button
and press the SET button.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
52
,
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
1
PRESET
/AUTO
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
nm
m
n Press the SET button to select "FORMAT".
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
All of data in the COPY1 is going
to be erased.
OK
CANCEL
m Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows but-
ton and press the SET button to start format-
ting.
To stop formatting, select "CANCEL" and press the SET but-
ton.
During formatting, the status window will be displayed.
The status window will be closed automatically after com-
pleting formatting.
, Press the SETUP/ESC button to close the
SETUP MENU window.
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor.
53
DISPLAY/EDIT TEXT INFORMATION
It is possible to attach text information to images when
recording.
Entering 20 characters for a line (up to 10 lines, with a total
of 200 characters) is possible.
x Press the SHIFT button.
The SHIFT indicator will light.
These are the descriptions of how to display/edit the
attached text information for images.
c Press the TEXT button to display the TEXT
INFORMATION window.
Note: Displaying/editing text information is possible during
the following.
TEXT INFORMATION
• While pausing playback on a single screen
• While displaying the recording event list window
[WJ-HD316]
cv
z
EDIT : [TEXT] SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
5
2
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
Text information attached to the paused playback image or
text information attached to the selected recording event
will be displayed.
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
6
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
To close the TEXT INFORMATION window, press the
SETUP/ESC button or the SET button.
BUSY
x
z
[WJ-HD309]
v Press the TEXT button again to edit text infor-
mation.
cv
z
PLAY
STOP
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
TEXT INFORMATION
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
BUSY
x
z
EXT : [TEXT]
z <While pausing playback on a single screen>
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to stop play-
back.
<While displaying the recording event list win-
dow>
Select a desired recording event by rotating
the jog dial.
TIME&DATE
CAMERA
REC EVENT
TEXT
UNLOCK FILTER
TEXT
TIME&DATE
CAM REC EVT
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM
TOTAL
100
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK
54
Important:
It is impossible to edit text information using the system
controller.
[WJ-HD316]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
PRESET
/AUTO
2
SET
13
BUSY
b
n
b
[WJ-HD309]
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
R
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
TEXT
COPY
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
6
9
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
REPEAT
–
+
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
PRESET
/AUTO
SET
BUSY
b
n
b
b Edit text information using the arrows button
and the jog dial.
• To insert a character
Move the cursor to a desired point where a character is
to be inserted using the arrows button, and select a
character using the jog dial.
• To delete a character
Move the cursor to a character to be deleted using the
arrows button, and press the STOP button.
• To delete all characters
Press the STOP button for 2 seconds or more.
• Available characters
The following characters can be entered:
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z a
b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z 0 12 3 4 5 6
7 8 9!"#$%' ()*+, - ./: ;<=>?@[ \ ] ^ _`{|}~
Press the TEXT button after editing text.
n Press the SET button to apply the edited char-
acters.
TEXT INFORMATION
Digital Disc Recorder WJ-HD316
EDIT : [TEXT] SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]
To cancel the edit, press the SETUP/ESC button. The edit-
ed characters will not be applied.
55
ERROR/WARNINGS
• The "error" status
When a fatal error (one that might cause the system to go down) has occurred, the ERROR indicator will blink red and the
error indication will be displayed on the monitor 2.
• The "warning" status
When an error (even though it has not caused the system trouble yet, but which may become a fatal error) has occurred,
the ERROR indicator will blink orange.
• When the buzzer sounding duration has passed from the error occurrence or the ALARM RESET button is pressed, the
error indication will disappear and the blinking ERROR indicator will light steadily. (Error half-reset)
If the error is eliminated, the ERROR indicator will go off when the ALARM RESET button is pressed while the ERROR indi-
cator is lit. (Error reset)
At an error occurrence
In the error half-reset
condition
In the error reset condition
Off
ERROR indicator on the
front panel
Blinks
Lights steadily
Sounds (when it has been
set)
Stops
Stops
Buzzer
Error display area on the
main bar
Displays
Displays
Does not display
Does not output
The error output (pin no.18)
of the ALARM/CONTROL
connector
Outputs
Does not output
Problem mail
Transmitted (When it has
been set)
–
–
–
–
Error log
Filed
Indication
ALT-*
Status
Description
Solution
Error
Error
Recorded image has been altered.
Playback will be paused.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the error status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to resume
playback.
W-ERROR
Failed to write data on the HDD.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the error status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
When the "W-ERROR" indication is dis-
played frequently, contact the dealer to
replace the hard disk drive.
SMART
Warning
Warning
The hard disk may be malfunctioning
and may not work correctly.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the warning status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
Contact the dealer to replace the hard
disk.
H-METER
The set time for the HOUR METER has
passed. (Refer to page 94.)
It may be reaching the end of the hard
disk’s lifetime.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the warning status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
Contact the dealer to replace the hard
disk.
56
Indication
THERMAL
Status
Warning
Description
Solution
Thermal error of the unit or the optional
extension unit has been detected.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the warning status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
If thermal errors occur frequently, the
unit may be malfunctioning. Contact the
dealer.
POWER
Warning
The power outage alert signal is sup-
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
plied from the uninterruptible power sup- cel the warning status. The unit will be in
ply system (UPS). Internal processing the error half-reset/error reset condition.
will start when the set time for "Shutdown The unit will start operation automatically
Time" on the "Basic Setup" menu of
"System" has passed after having
received the power outage alert signal.
(Refer to page 122.) When the internal
processing starts, recording will stop
and all operations will be invalid.
after the UPS starts power supply.
#-nn% (available
disk space is run-
ning out)
#-FULL (no avail-
able disk space)
Error
Warning
The hard disk is almost full or completely Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
full.
cel the error/warning status. The unit will
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-
dition. Initialize or replace the hard disk.
(Refer to page 128, 133.) When initial-
ized, all recorded data will be deleted. It
is recommended to copy the data using
an external recording device.
The DVD-RAM disk is almost full or com- Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
pletely full.
cel the error/warning status. The unit will
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-
dition. Initialize the DVD-RAM disk.
(Refer to page 52.) When initialized, all
recorded data will be deleted.
The CD-R or DVD-R disk is almost full or Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
completely full.
cel the error/warning status. The unit will
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-
dition. Replace the disk with a new one.
MEDIUM-n
Warning
The external recording device is not
operable because no disk or different
format disk has been inserted, etc.
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
cel the warning status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset/error reset condition.
Confirm that a disk has been inserted, or
check the inserted disk format.
REMOVE
FAN
Error
An error has occurred on the hard disk
and the hard disk has been unmounted hard disk, the "REMOVE" error status will
from the system automatically. be canceled.
Consult the dealer. After replacing the
Warning
The fan of this unit or the optional exten- Press the ALARM RESET button to can-
sion unit is malfunctioning. It may pro-
duce an increase in temperature in the
cel the warning status. The unit will be in
the error half-reset condition. Consult the
unit and cause malfunction of the HDDs. dealer.
* : Camera number
# : Partition number (Refer to page 14.)
nn : Available disk space (percentage)
n : COPY port number to which an external recording device is connected
Note: The available disk space warning will be given only once when the available disk space has reached the set value. Mail
notification of an available disk space warning will be sent each time 1 % of the available disk space is reduced after the
available disk space has reached the set value. Refer to page 95 for descriptions of how to set the available disk space
(Disk Capacity) warning. For further information about mail notification of available disk space warning, refer to the Network
Setup Instructions (PDF).
57
OPERATION USING A SYSTEM CONTROLLER
It is possible to operate this unit using a PS·Data compatible system controller.
The following are the descriptions of how to operate this unit using the system controller WV-CU360C.
To operate this unit using a PS·Data compatible system controller, perform the required settings in advance. Refer to a system
administrator for further information.
Note: To perform the operation with buttons with the shadowed background ( ), press the SHIFT button of the system con-
troller to light the SHIFT indicator on the right side of the SHIFT button.
Item
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
WV-CU360C
Note
SETUP
SETUP
/ESC
Open/Close the SETUP
MENU
Press the button [0] to delete a character in the
SETUP MENU.
FUNCTION
UP
UP
UP
L
R
L
R
R
L
R
Select an item
DOWN
DOWN
DOWN
REV
FWD
EL-ZOOM
+
STILL
Rotate
the jog
dial
Change the set para-
meter
–
+
–
CAM
Change the cursor
position
SET
SET
SET
CAM
Press a button on the
pop-up menu
SET
MON
SETUP
/ESC
Return to the previous
menu
ESC
SETUP
Set on the SETUP
MENU
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
Summer time OFF
Summer time ON
FUNCTION
SETUP
Set on the SETUP
MENU
FUNCTION
SETUP
Set on the SETUP
MENU
Timer recording OFF
Timer recording EXT
FUNCTION
SETUP
Set on the SETUP
MENU
FUNCTION
SETUP
SEARCH
SEARCH
SEARCH
Display the recording
event list
Press the [5] button to display the search filter
window. Press the SET button to start playback.
FUNCTION
SETUP
Display the VMD
search list
Press the [5] button to display the VMD search
list. Press the SET button to start playback.
FUNCTION
SETUP
Display the marking list
Press the SET button to start playback.
Press the SET button to start playback.
FUNCTION
SETUP
Display the menu for
playback by designat-
ing time and date
SEARCH
→
FUNCTION
UP
UP
Move the cursor to
search for an item
R
L
R
Press Aor B.
DOWN
DOWN
Switch displaying the
list window and the
thumbnail window
alternately
UP
L
R
L
R
Press Cor D.
DOWN
REV
FWD
EL-ZOOM
+
STILL
Display a list/thumbnail
Move the cursor to
select
Rotate
the jog
dial
–
+
–
58
Item
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
WV-CU360C
Note
MON
SETUP
/ESC
Close the search win-
dow
Pressing the SETUP button can also close the
search window.
ESC
ALM RESET
ALARM
RESET
Alarm reset
ALM RECALL
ALM SUSPEND
ALARM
RESET
+
Alarm suspension
Manual recording
Stop manual recording
SET
SETUP
REC
-
REC STOP
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
FUNCTION
SETUP
Press for 2
seconds or
more
REC
-
REC STOP
Available only during recording
FUNCTION
SETUP
Stop playback/manual
recording
Both recording and playback will be stopped if
operating the controller as shown on the left.
–
FUNCTION
SETUP
PLAY
PAUSE
Press the SET button to play the selected result
from the search window.
Play
FUNCTION
SETUP
STOP
Stop playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
REV
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
–
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
Play at normal speed
Play at 2x speed
Play at 5x speed
Play at 10x speed
Play at 20x speed
Play at 50x speed
Play at 100x speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at normal
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 2x
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 5x
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 10x
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 20x
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 50x
speed
FUNCTION
SETUP
During
playback/
pause
Rotate
the shut-
tle ring
Reverse play at 100x
speed
FUNCTION
59
Item
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
WV-CU360C
Note
SETUP
PLAY
PAUSE
→
→
→
Pause playback
Available only during playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
REV
FWD
Rotate
the jog-
daial
–
+
Skip to the next frame
Available only during pause
Available only during pause
During
pause
FUNCTION
SETUP
REV
FWD
Rotate
the jog-
daial
Skip to the previous
frame
–
+
During
pause
FUNCTION
SETUP
REV
FWD
The point to be skipped to will be different
between normal playback and filtered play-
back.
The point to be skipped to will be different
between normal playback and filtered play-
back.
Rotate
the jog-
daial
–
+
→
→
Skip forward
During
playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
REV
FWD
Rotate
the jog-
daial
–
+
Skip backward
During
playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
A-B
ZOOM/
FOCUS
Mark start point for the
A - B repeat playback
REPEAT
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
Available only during playback/pause
Available only during playback/pause
Available only during playback/pause
Available only during playback/pause
Available only during the filtered playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
A-B
ZOOM/
FOCUS
Mark end point for the
A - B repeat playback
REPEAT
FUNCTION
SETUP
A-B
ZOOM/
FOCUS
Cancel the A-B repeat
playback
REPEAT
FUNCTION
SETUP
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
Skip to the latest
recorded image
FUNCTION
SETUP
IRIS
IRIS
LISTED
Filtering off
Filtering on
FUNCTION
SETUP
LISTED
Mark
Available only when it is possible to switch to
the filtered playback
FUNCTION
SETUP
SHIFT
SHIFT
Mark a point
(For the WJ-HD316)
+
Available only during playback/pause
Available only during playback/pause
12
FUNCTION
SETUP
Mark
Mark a point
(For the WJ-HD309)
+
+
9
FUNCTION
Select the normal
recording area/event
recording area of the
HDD (For the WJ-
HD316)
SETUP
DISK SELECT
SHIFT
→
→
9
7
FUNCTION
Select the normal
recording area/event
recording area of the
HDD (For the WJ-
HD309)
SETUP
DISK SELECT
SHIFT
+
FUNCTION
Select the copy area of
the HDD (For the WJ-
HD316)
SETUP
DISK SELECT
DISK SELECT
SHIFT
SHIFT
+
+
→
→
9
7
FUNCTION
SETUP
Select the copy area of
the HDD (For the WJ-
HD309)
FUNCTION
MON
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
→
→
Select monitor 1
Select monitor 2
ESC
MON
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ESC
60
Item
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
WV-CU360C
Note
SEQUENCE
SEQ
SHIFT
Sequential display ON
(For the WJ-HD316)
It is possible to stop the sequential display by
pressing a camera selection button.
+
7
SEQUENCE
S E Q
SHIFT
Sequential display ON
(For the WJ-HD309)
It is possible to stop the sequential display by
pressing a camera selection button.
+
4
CAM
Camera
number
Select a camera
(For the WJ-HD316)
Camera selection but-
tons (1 - 16)
→
SET
CAM
Camera
number
Select a camera
(For the WJ-HD309)
Camera selection but-
tons (1 - 9)
→
SET
MULTI SCREEN SELECT
Switches in the following order each time the
button is pressed
Select a multi-screen
(For the WJ-HD316)
SHIFT
+
1
1 - 4 CH → 5 - 8 CH → 9 - 12 CH → 13 - 16 CH
→ 1 - 7 CH → 1 - 9 CH → 10 - 16 CH
→ 1 - 13 CH → 1 - 16 CH
SHIFT
+
6
MULTI SCREEN SELECT
Switches in the following order each time the
button is pressed
Select a multi-screen
(For the WJ-HD309)
SHIFT
+
1
1 - 4 CH → 5 - 8 CH → 9 CH → 1 - 7 CH
→ 1 - 9 CH
SHIFT
+
3
EL-ZOOM
EL-ZOOM
EL-ZOOM
SHIFT
SHIFT
Zooming level changes in this order:
2x → 4x → 1x
Electronic zoom
(For the WJ-HD316)
13
+
+
+
EL-ZOOM
Zooming level changes in this order:
2x → 4x → 1x
Electronic zoom
(For the WJ-HD309)
+
Available only during pause
Text information display
ON (For the WJ-HD316)
SETUP
TEXT
SHIFT
SHIFT
It is possible to turn the text information display
off by pressing the ESC button when displaying
text information.
+
+
→
→
11
FUNCTION
SETUP
Available only during pause
Text information display
ON (For the WJ-HD309)
TEXT
It is possible to turn the text information display
off by pressing the ESC button when displaying
text information.
5
FUNCTION
SETUP
SHIFT
SHIFT
COPY
Display the DATA COPY
menu (For the WJ-HD316)
Available only when displaying live images or a
list, or when pausing playback
→
→
→
→
→
→
+
+
10/0
FUNCTION
SETUP
COPY
Display the DATA COPY
menu (For the WJ-HD309)
Available only when displaying live images or a
list, or when pausing playback
8
FUNCTION
SETUP
SHIFT
COPY
Cancel copying
(For the WJ-HD316)
During
copying
+
+
10/0
FUNCTION
SETUP
SHIFT
COPY
Cancel copying
(For the WJ-HD309)
During
copying
8
FUNCTION
SETUP
OSD
SHIFT
Switch displayed informa-
tion (For the WJ-HD316)
+
8
6
FUNCTION
SETUP
OSD
SHIFT
Switch displayed informa-
tion (For the WJ-HD309)
+
FUNCTION
61
OPERATION USING A PC
It is possible to perform the settings or operate the unit
using a web browser installed on a PC when this unit is
connected to a network.
The available features and the system requirements of a
PC are as follows.
I System Requirements of a PC
It is recommended to operate this unit using a PC that
meets the following system requirements. If using a PC that
does not meet the following system requirements, it may
cause problems such as slow imaging or the browser
becomes unable to operate.
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) on the
provided CD-ROM.
OS:
One of the following operating systems:
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Professional SP4
Microsoft® Windows® XP Professional or Home Edition
SP1
I Features
It is possible to operate this unit using a web browser in
much the same way as using the buttons on the front panel
of this unit.
PC:
The following functions are available when using a PC via a
network as well as the functions operable using the buttons
on the front panel of the unit.
IBM PC/AT Compatible
CPU:
Intel® Pentium® 4, 1.4 GHz or faster
ꢀ Downloading/transmitting images
Memory:
It is possible to download (save) the currently displayed
image in the web browser window onto the hard disk of a
PC. By establishing an FTP server, it is possible to transmit
images to a designated FTP server. When an event occurs,
it is possible to transmit images from the camera installed
in the place where the event occurred.
512 MB or more
Monitor:
1024 x 768 pixels or more, HIGH colour 16 bit or more
Interface:
Built-in network interface card compatible 10/100 Mbps
Recommended web browser:
ꢀ Event notification function
Microsoft Internet Explorer 5.5SP2, 6.0 SP1
Other web browsers are not compatible with this unit.
When an event occurs, it is possible to send e-mails to
designated addresses to notify of the event occurrence. It
is also possible to send an e-mail with a recorded image of
the place where the event occurred.
Important:
The plug-in software must be installed. The plug-in soft-
ware will be downloaded and installed automatically
when accessing the unit using a browser. If the plug-in
software has not been downloaded/installed correctly,
install it from the provided CD-ROM.
ꢀ Host authentication
It is possible to restrict devices from operating this unit if
their IP addresses are not registered.
Refer to "readme.txt" on the provided CD-ROM for the
descriptions of how to install it.
62
OPERATION OF THE UNIT IN THE CASCADE CONNECTION
When connecting multiple units (up to 4 units) in the cascade connection, it is possible to monitor images from all of the WJ-
HD316/309 in the cascade connection using a monitor. It is necessary in advance to perform the settings to operate the unit in
the cascade connection. Refer to a system administrator for further information.
I Features
It is possible to operate the unit in the cascade connection using the buttons on the front panel in the same way as operating a
unit used independently. Images will be displayed on monitor 2 connected to the first WJ-HD316/309. When using an optional
PS·Data compatible controller, it is possible to operate all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade connection.
Important:
• It is impossible to use monitor1 when connecting the units in the cascade connection. Do not operate the monitor switch
button on the front panel after selecting "MONITOR 2" for all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade connection.
• Video output signal will not be supplied from the MONITOR (VGA) connector when connecting the units in the cascade
connection.
• Using the AUDIO IN and AUDIO OUT connectors on the first unit is possible. It is impossible to use the AUDIO IN and
AUDIO OUT connectors on the second and subsequent units.
I Operation using the buttons on the front panel
It is possible to operate the unit using the buttons on the front panel as described on pages 19 - 57. Images will be displayed
on monitor 2 connected to the first unit. When operating the buttons on the front panel, only live/recorded images from the
cameras connected to the currently operated unit are available. It is impossible to operate live/recorded images from the cam-
eras connected to the other units.
PS·Data compatible
system controller
Monitor 2
System Controller
I Operation using a system controller
It is possible to operate all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade
connection using an optional PS·Data compatible controller by
designating a unit number. Refer to the operating instructions of
the system controller or page 58 for descriptions of how to oper-
ate a PS·Data compatible system controller.
First unit
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
REV
REV
REV
FWD
FWD
FWD
FWD
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
–
+
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
Live image/
Images can be
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
HDD
2
13
SET
Device to be operated recorded image/
operated
BUSY
camera control
ꢁ
System controller
From any camera
Second unit
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
TIMER
From only the cam-
eras connected to
the first unit
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
First unit (front panel)
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ꢁ
ꢁ
ꢁ
ꢁ
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
–
+
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
HDD
2
13
SET
BUSY
From only the cam-
eras connected to
the second unit
Second unit (front panel)
Third unit (front panel)
Fourth unit (front panel)
Third unit
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
From only the cam-
eras connected to
the third unit
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
–
+
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
From only the cam-
eras connected to
the fourth unit
HDD
2
13
SET
BUSY
Fourth unit
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
PULL
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
Note: It is impossible to display images from two units of
TIMER
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
ALARM
SEARCH
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
the WJ-HD316/309 or more on a multi-screen.
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
–
+
ALARM
RESET
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
LOGOUT
IRIS
LISTED
9
10/0
14
11
15
12
16
HDD
1
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD
HDD
2
13
SET
BUSY
63
INSTALLATION IN THE RACK
1. Remove the rubber legs (6 pcs.) on the bottom of the
unit.
• Use a flat-blade screwdriver and remove the screws.
Remove the rubber legs.
2. Install the rack mounting brackets on both sides of the
unit.
• Using the mounting screws (4 pcs.) for the rack mount-
ing brackets, fix them firmly.
Mounting screws for rack mounting brackets
(accessories)
Rack mounting brackets (accessories)
3. Install the unit in the rack.
• Fix the unit firmly with the rack mounting screws (4
pcs.).
Rack mounting screws
For our rack: Nominal diameter 5 tapping (accessory)
Important:
• The cooling fan inside the unit is perishable and must be replaced periodically.
• Do not block the ventilation openings or slots in the cover to prevent the unit from overheating.
• If the rack is subject to vibration, secure the rear of the unit to the rack using additional mounting brackets (not included).
• Keep the temperature in the rack below +45 °C (113 °F).
• When installing, install the unit lower in the rack with a space equivalent to about 1 unit (44 mm) or more separating it from
the other appliances.
64
MANAGEMENT OF USERS/HOSTS
It is necessary in advance to register users and PCs (hosts) who access this unit via a network such as a LAN.
Up to 32 users and 8 hosts can be registered.
The following information can be registered as user information and host information.
Item
Description
Note
User name
Name of user who logs into this unit. Enter this Item to be set only for user registration
in the login window.
Host IP address
IP address of a PC that accesses this unit.
Only PCs with registered IP addresses can
access this unit if ON is selected for "Host
Authentication".
Item to be set only for host registration
Item to be set only for user registration
Password
Level
Password of user who logs into this unit. Enter
this in the login window.
Level of users or hosts for operable functions.
Refer to page 125 for further information.
Priority
Priority of controllable functions. When two or
more users/hosts performed the same opera-
tion, only a user/host with the highest priority
can perform the operation.
Determine the priority in the following cases:
• A user tries to log in after another user has
already logged in.
• A user tries to control a camera that is being
controlled by another user.
Default screen
Startup display to be displayed on monitor 1,
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor after login.
Camera partitioning
Controllable range for each camera channel.
For the set items above, the unit will work differently depending on whether the unit is operated directly or operated via a net-
work as follows.
ꢀ When the unit is operated directly
Operate using the monitor connected with this unit. There are 3 ways to operate this unit as follows:
• Operate using the buttons on the front panel of the unit
• Operate using a PS·Data compatible controller
Note: The priority setting of this unit will not be applied when controlling the cameras connected to the coaxial communica-
tion using a PS·Data compatible controller. (Post-priority will be applied.)
• Operate using a PC connected to the SERIAL connector (RS232C) on the rear panel of the unit
It is impossible to log into the unit simultaneously by the above methods (except when using the same user name to log in).
When a user tries to log in after another user has already logged into the unit, the unit will work as follows according to the set-
ting for "Priority" of "System".
Setting for "Priority"
Description
Follow the priority
When a user’s priority is higher than the one of the other user
who has already logged in, this user can log in and the other
user who has already logged in will be forced to log out.
When a user’s priority is lower than the one of the other user
who has already logged in, this user cannot log in.
Pre-priority
Post-priority
When another user has already logged in, any user except
administrators cannot log in regardless of priority.
When an administrator has logged in, the other user who has
already logged in will be forced to log out.
Any user can log in regardless of priority.
65
Notes:
• When a user is operating this unit using a PS·Data compatible controller, this user can log in automatically as a PSD user
set for "PSD User" of "System" on the SETUP MENU.
• When a user logged into this unit using a PS·Data compatible controller and didn’t operate the unit for around 2 minutes,
this PSD user will be forced to log out.
ꢀ When the unit is operated using a PC via a network
Operate using a PC via a network. Up to 8 hosts (PCs) can access the unit.
When a host tries to log in after 8 hosts have already logged in the unit, the unit will work as follows according to the setting for
"Priority" of "System".
Setting for "Priority"
Description
Follow the priority
When a host’s priority is higher than the one of the other host
who has already logged in, this host can log in and the other
host who has already logged in will be forced to log out.
When a host’s priority is lower than the one of the other host
who has already logged in, this host cannot log in.
Pre-priority
Post-priority
Any host cannot log in regardless of priority. However, it is
possible to log in as an administrator by operating the but-
tons on the front panel of the unit. In this case, users who
have already logged in will be forced to log out.
Any host can log in regardless of priority.
When accessing the unit using a PC via a network, the unit will work as follows according to the setting for "User
Authentication" and "Host Authentication" of "NW Setup 1".
Setting for "User
Authentication"
Setting for "Host
Authentication"
User/Host to log in
Note
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
Log into the unit as an admin-
istrator.
ON
Log into the unit as a regis-
tered user.
The login window will be dis-
played.
OFF
ON
Log into the unit as a regis-
tered host.
The login window will not be
displayed.
ON
Log into the unit as a regis-
tered user.
It is impossible to log in for
an unregistered host.
66
OPERATING THE UNIT FOR THE FIRST TIME
Important:
v Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
When connecting an optional extension unit (the WJ-
HDE300 series), turn on the power of the extension unit
before turning on the power of this unit.
more.
The SETUP MENU will be displayed.
Adjust the clock of the unit with this menu.
Refer to page 17 for further information about clock adjust-
ment.
z Turn on the POWER switch.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
x Press the SET button when the system check
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
complete window is displayed.
The HDD DISK MENU window will be displayed.
Perform the settings with this menu according to your
needs.
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
Refer to page 16 for further information.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
b With the default setting, the unit is ready to
start manual recording. Perform the settings
for recordings or event actions according to
your needs.
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
After completing the settings, press any button to close the
HDD DISK MENU.
The login window will be displayed.
When "ON" is selected for "Auto Login" of "Basic Setup" on
the "System" menu, the login window will not be displayed.
(The default setting is ON.)
c Enter a user name and password.
Live images will be displayed after logging in.
Refer to page 16 for further information about the user
name and password.
Notes:
• With the default setting, the disk space is set as the nor-
mal recording area. Perform the settings for each
recording area according to your needs.
• The default user name and password are as follows:
User name: ADMIN
Password: 12345
• To enhance the security, change the password for an
administrator periodically.
67
v Move the cursor to "HDD Safety Mode" and
Preparation for maintenance (HDD
replacement, installation, etc.)
rotate the jog dial to select "ON ".
When maintaining (HDD replacement, installation, etc.)
without turning the power of the unit off, carry out the follow-
ing operation after setting the HDD SAFETY MODE to ON.
(The default setting is ON.)
This can be set on the "Disk Info" menu of "Maintenance".
Refer to page 94 for further information.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
1
2
3
4
REC Rate
Remaining
Normal REC Area 1800GB
Event REC Area 1200GB
Copy Area
Copy 1(Rear)
Copy 2(Front)
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
MAIN
EXT1
EXT2
EXT3
EXT4
EXT5
EXT6
EXT7
Disk Info
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
1000GB
1000GB
1000GB
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
Event Log
Error Log
160GB
15000h
3000h
ON
Warning for Disk Life Time
HDD Safety Mode
I
I
Access Log
Important:
After completing the installation or the maintenance, set
the HDD SAFETY MODE to OFF.
b Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
Do the following before starting operation when maintaining
(HDD replacement, installation, etc.).
more.
The SETUP MENU will be closed.
The unit will restart automatically and the HDD SAFETY
MODE window will be displayed.
The HDD safety mode will begin.
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or
more.
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the
VGA monitor.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
The camera selection buttons (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 -
9, 0 for the WJ-HD309) will light green and orange (for 2
seconds each) alternately.
The following window will be displayed after around 30 sec-
onds.
x Select "System" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
Start maintenance after this window is displayed.
The procedures are different between the replacement of
the hard disks and the installation of the unit (rack mount-
ing/unmounting).
c Move the cursor to "Disk Info" using the
arrows button (CD) and press the SET but-
ton.
Refer to the following descriptions.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
1
2
3
4
REC Rate
Remaining
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
MAIN
EXT1
EXT2
EXT3
EXT4
EXT5
EXT6
EXT7
Normal REC Area
Event REC Area
Copy Area
1800GB
Disk Info
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
1200GB
1000GB
1000GB
1000GB
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
COPY 1 (Rear)
COPY 2 (Front)
Event Log
Error Log
Warning for Disk Life Time
HDD Safety Mode
3000h
OFF
I
I
Access Log
68
When the system check has been completed, the HDD
SAFETY MODE window (as shown below) will be displayed.
The camera selection buttons on the front panel (1 - 16 for
the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9, 0 for the WJ-HD309) will light green
and orange (for 2 seconds each) alternately.
The "REMOVING" indication will return to "REMOVE" by
attaching the cable to the front panel. The power will be
supplied to the front panel and the unit will be enabled to
operate with the front panel.
ꢀ When replacing the built-in hard disk of the
extension unit
Once displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window in step 5,
start replacing the built-in hard disk of the optional exten-
sion unit.
Refer to the operating instructions of the extension unit for
the descriptions of how to replace the hard disk.
Move the cursor to OFF using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
ꢀ When installing/uninstalling the unit
into/from the rack (rack mounting/unmount-
ing)
Once displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window in step 5,
start installing/uninstalling the unit.
The unit will restart automatically and the system check
complete window will be displayed.
When the system check complete window is displayed,
carry out the procedures described on page 67 (start from
z).
Important:
Detach the cable from the front panel after confirming
that "REMOVING" is displayed. Otherwise, it may cause
malfunction.
ꢀ When replacing the built-in hard disk of the
unit
Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
The "REMOVE" indication will change to "REMOVING".
The power supply to the front panel will be cut and the unit
will be unable to operate with the front panel.
Detach the cable from the front panel and start replacing
the built-in hard disk.
Start from step 2 on page 128 to replace the built-in hard
disk.
69
CONNECTIONS
Important
When connecting the Panasonic matrix switcher or the data multiplex unit to this unit, the looped through output signal for
every video input signal from them must be supplied to the video input connectors of this unit directly.
Do not supply the monitor output signal or the spot output signal from the matrix switcher or the data multiplex unit to the video
input connectors of this unit.
Otherwise, the images may be disorderly displayed and recorded for a split second. (The images displayed before switching
channel may be displayed and recorded.)
I Connections when the unit is used independently
An example of connections is shown below when the unit is used independently.
Important:
• The power plug should be connected last.
• When connecting combination cameras, connect them to the video input connectors 1 - 8 when using the WJ-HD316 or 1 -
6 when using the WJ-HD309 (for coaxial communication).
ꢀ Examples of connections
Monitor 1
Monitor 2
Mode switch setting (Factory default)
ON
Microphone
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Note: If the DATA and RS485 ports are not
used, the mode switches should be used as
illustrated.
Amplifier
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
4
OUT
POWER
AC IN
2
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
120 V AC
50 Hz
For Audio Amplifier
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
System cameras
(VIDEO IN 9 - 16)
Combination cameras
(VIDEO IN 1 - 8)
Notes:
• The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP MENU on
monitor 1.)
• The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be displayed on the VGA monitor.
• Depending on the connected monitor, flickering may occur when displaying the SETUP MENU. In this case, it is rec-
ommended to use the VGA monitor or a dirtectly connected PC using a LAN cable to perform the settings. (Refer to the
Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for descriptions of how to connect this unit and a PC directly.)
70
I Connections with an extension unit
An example of connections is shown below when the unit is used together with an optional extension unit.
This unit can be connected with up to seven extension units.
Connect the EXT IN port on the rear panel of the extension unit and the EXT STORAGE port on the rear panel of this unit using
the cable provided with the optional extension unit.
Important:
• Use the cable provided with the optional extension unit.
• Fix the cables with the cable clamp (provided with each unit) to prevent disconnection or unstable connections that may
cause recording failures or an unstable system.
How to fix the cable clamp
Cable Clamp
Fixing screw
A
Remove this screw from the
unit and fix the cables with the
cable clamp using the provided
screw for the cable clamp.
G
E
1
2
1
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
This unit
Cable (attached to the extension unit)
SIGNAL GND
POWER
AC IN
EXT
IN
OUT
2
1
Extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series)
Cable Clamp
EXT
Fixing screw
IN
OUT
Remove this screw from the
unit and fix the cables with the
cable clamp using the provided
screw for the cable clamp.
2
1
How to fix the cable clamp
71
I Connections with DVD-RAM, CD-R, and DVD-R drives
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the designated DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R drive.
Connect the designated DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R drive and the COPY1 port on the rear panel or the COPY2 port inside the
connectors cover on the front panel of this unit using an USB cable (not included).
Important:
• Use an appropriate USB cable compatible with the USB2.0 standard.
• Fix the cables with the cable clamp (provided with this unit) to prevent disconnection or unstable connections that may
cause recording failures or an unstable system.
Designated DVD-RAM drive, etc.
R
O
M
How to fix the cable clamp
Cable Clamp
USB cable (Locally procured)
Fixing screw
Y
/
Remove this screw from the
RA
2
GE
1
unit and fix the cables with the
cable clamp using the provided
screw for the cable clamp.
1
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
Rear
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
TIMER
S-VIDEO
1
2
3
4
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
SEARCH
ALARM
VIDEO
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
COPY
2
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
OUT
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
5
9
6
7
8
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
ALARM
RESET
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
12
10/0
11
AUDIO
OUT
HDD 1
HDD 2
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
Front
USB cable (Locally procured)
R
O
M
Designated DVD-RAM drive, etc.
72
I Connections with the VTR
When it is necessary to copy the recorded images to a video tape using a VTR, connect the VTR to the S-VIDEO connector (or
the VIDEO OUT connector) and the AUDIO OUT connector inside the connectors cover on the front panel of this unit as below.
Open the connectors cover.
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
-
REC STOP
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
REV
FWD
TIMER
S-VIDEO
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/
TILT
GOTO
LAST
ERROR
SEARCH
ALARM
VIDEO
SHIFT
SEQ
OSD
COPY
2
SETUP
/ESC
PAN/TILT
SLOW
OUT
ZOOM/
FOCUS
A-B
ALARM
SUSPEND
REPEAT
ALARM
RESET
–
+
DISK SELECT
EL-ZOOM
COPY
TEXT
MARK
IRIS
LISTED
9
12
10/0
11
AUDIO
OUT
HDD 1
HDD 2
PRESET
/AUTO
OPERATE
LOGOUT
SET
13
14
15
16
BUSY
AUDIO
IN
Audio cable with an RCA pin plug (Locally procured)
Audio cable with an RCA pin plug (Locally procured)
VTR
VIDEO
IN
S-VIDEO IN
connector
S-video cable (Locally procured)
Note: The same video signal supplied to the MONITOR1 connector and to the MONITOR2 (VGA) connector will be supplied to
the S-VIDEO connector and the VIDEO OUT connector inside the connectors cover.
The same audio signal supplied to the AUDIO OUT connector on the rear panel of this unit will be supplied to the AUDIO
OUT connector inside the connectors cover on the front panel.
73
I Connections with PS·Data systems
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the PS·Data devices.
If a connected system controller is PS·Data compatible, it is possible to operate this unit or connected devices using the sys-
tem controller.
Use the RS485 cable provided with the system controller.
Important:
• Terminate both devices on both ends of the connection. Refer to the respective operating instructions for the descriptions
of how to terminate. Termination of this unit can be set with the mode switch on the rear panel. (See below.)
• When connecting a PS·Data compatible device, it is necessary to set each item of "PS·Data Setup" of "Comm" on the
SETUP MENU according to the system configuration.
• The PS·Data is our exclusive protocol. Contact the dealer about devices that can be connected.
ꢀ When connecting this unit with a controller
System Controller
RS485 cable (provided with the controller)
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: ON)
(No. 8: OFF)
Controller
Termination: ON
Unit Address : 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
2
POWER
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
15
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
AC IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU
• Unit Address (System) : 1
• Unit Address (Controller) : 2
74
ꢀ When installing this unit between a controller and a system device
System Controller
RS485 cable
UNIT
0
ALARM
RESET
POWER
ALARM
SUSPEND
SUSPEND
SET
SET UP
4
5
ALARM
ESC
ON
1
2
3
OFF
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204
Coaxial communication unit
Termination: ON
Unit Address : 2
Controller
Termination: ON
Unit Address : 1
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Mode switch
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
2
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU
• Unit Address (System) : 1
• Unit Address (Controller) : 2
ꢀ When connecting this unit with a system device
RS485 cable
UNIT
0
ALARM
RESET
POWER
ALARM
SUSPEND
SUSPEND
SET
SET UP
4
5
ALARM
ESC
ON
1
2
3
OFF
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204
Coaxial communication unit
Termination: ON
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: ON)
Unit Address : 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
RS485 cable
MODE
2
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
UNIT
0
ALARM
RESET
OUT
POWER
ALARM
SUSPEND
SUSPEND
SET
SET UP
4
5
ALARM
ESC
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
ON
VIDEO
1
2
3
OFF
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204
Coaxial communication unit
Termination: OFF
Unit Address : 2
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU
• Unit Address (System) : 1
• Unit Address (Controller) : 1
75
I Cascade connection of multiple units
Up to of four units can be connected.
For the cascade connection, connect the CASCADE IN connector and the CASCADE OUT connector on the rear panel of each
unit as below.
Important:
• When connecting the unit in the cascade connection, set "Cascade" of "PS·Data Setup" in "Comm" on the SETUP MENU to
"ON". (Page 116)
• It is impossible to use this connector when connecting the unit in the cascade connection.
ꢀ When no PS·Data compatible device is connected to the system
Monitor 2
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: ON)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Unit Address settings
of "PS·Data Setup"
of "Comm" on the
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
SETUP MENU
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
First unit (this unit)
System : 1
Controller : 1
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 Cable
Mode switch
ON
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Second unit
System : 2
Controller : 2
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 Cable
Mode switch
ON
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
(No. 7: ON)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Third unit
System : 3
Controller : 3
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
76
ꢀ When the PS·Data compatible device is connected to the first unit
Controller
Termination: ON
Unit Address : 1
Monitor 2
System Controller
RS485 cable
(provided with
Mode switch
the controller)
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Unit Address settings
of "PS·Data Setup"
of "Comm" on the
SETUP MENU
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITR OUT CASCDE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
First unit (this unit)
System : 1
Controller : 2
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 cable
Mode switch
ON
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Second unit
System : 2
Controller : 3
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 cable
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: ON)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Third unit
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
System : 3
Controller : 4
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
77
ꢀ When the PS·Data compatible device is connected to the third unit
Monitor 2
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: ON)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Unit Address settings
of "PS·Data Setup"
of "Comm" on the
SETUP MENU
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
First unit (this unit)
System : 1
Controller : 1
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 cable
Mode switch
ON
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Second unit
System : 2
Controller : 2
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 cable
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Third unit
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
System : 3
Controller : 3
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
Coaxial communication unit
Termination: ON
Unit Address: 4
UNIT
0
ALARM
RESET
POWER
ALARM
SUSPEND
SUSPEND
SET
SET UP
ESC
5
ALARM
ON
1
2
3
4
OFF
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204
RS485 cable
78
ꢀ When the PS·Data compatible devices are connected to the first and third units
·
PS Data Compatible
System Controller
Monitor 2
Controller
Termination: ON
Unit Address: 1
RS485 cable
(provided with
the controller)
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Unit Address settings
of "PS·Data Setup"
of "Comm" on the
SETUP MENU
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
First unit (this unit)
System : 1
Controller : 2
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
RS485 cable
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
Mode switch
ON
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
Second unit
System : 2
Controller : 3
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
BNC Cable
(Locally procured)
RS485 cable
Mode switch
ON
(No. 7: OFF)
(No. 8: OFF)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
Third unit
System : 3
Controller : 4
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
UNIT
0
ALARM
RESET
POWER
ALARM
SUSPEND
Coaxial communication unit
Termination: ON
Unit Address: 5
SUSPEND
SET
SET UP
4
ALARM
ESC
ON
1
2
3
OFF
RS485 cable
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204
79
I Connection with the RS485 camera
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the RS485 devices.
Up to eight cameras can be connected using a single RS485 (CAMERA) port.
Important:
• Terminate both devices on both ends of the connection. Refer to the respective operating instructions for the descriptions
of how to terminate. Termination of this unit can be set with the mode switch on the rear panel.
• When connecting an RS485 camera, it is necessary to set each item of "RS485 Setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU
according to the RS485 settings of the camera. (Refer to page 117.)
• The total length of the RS485 cable from this unit is 1 200 meters at the maximum.
ꢀ 1:1 connection
Connect a camera to the RS485 (CAMERA) port.
Example: When the RS485 cameras are connected to the CAMERA IN connectors 9 and 13:
Mode switch
ON
(No. 1, No. 4 : ON)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
SIGNAL GND
4
1
2
MODE
COPY
SERIAL
ALARM
CASCADE
OUT
3
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
PS·DATA
5
RS-485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXIT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
9
7
7
6
6
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
8
5
4
2
1
CAMERA
RS485 cable
RS485 cable
Unit No.13
Termination: ON
Unit No.9
Termination: ON
Combination Cameras
Connect the RS485 camera to Switches required to be set
4-wire communication
2-wire communication
No.2
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
RS485 (1)
No.3
No.5
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
RS485 (2)
No.6
80
ꢀ Daisy connection
Multiple cameras can be connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port.
Example: When cameras 1 - 4 are connected to one of the RS485 (CAMERA) port and cameras 9 - 12 are connected to the
other RS485 (CAMERA) port.
RS485 cable
Mode switch
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Nos. 1,2,3,4,5,6 : ON
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
2
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
15
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
Unit No. 12 Unit No. 11 Unit No. 10 Unit No. 9
Termination: Termination: Termination: Termination:
ON OFF OFF OFF
Unit No. 4
Unit No. 3
Unit No. 2
Unit No. 1
Termination: Termination: Termination: Termination:
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
Connect the RS485 camera to Switches required to be set
4-wire communication
2-wire communication
No.2
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
RS485 (1)
No.3
No.5
OFF
OFF
ON
ON
RS485 (2)
No.6
81
I Mode Switch
RS485 interface is used to communicate between this unit and the PS·Data compatible system device. In this case, it is neces-
sary to terminate both devices on both ends of the RS485 connection.
The settings of the mode switch will be different depending on whether this unit is used as a receiver or a controller.
When an RS 485 camera is connected to this unit, it is necessary to terminate both devices on both ends of the connection.
• When connecting this unit with the system controller and
this is installed at the end of the PS·Data connection
PS·Data termination switch 1: ON
RS485 (1) terminating switch
RS485 (1) 2/4-wire changeover
RS485 (2) terminating switch
• When connecting a system device and this unit is installed
at the end of the PS·Data connection
PS·Data terminating switch 2: ON
RS485 (2) 2/4-wire changeover
PS•Data terminating switch 1
PS•Data terminating switch 2
• When connecting RS485 cameras
Set the termination switch of the connected RS485 (CAMERA)
port to ON.
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the RS485 (1)
termination switch to ON.
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the RS485 (2)
termination switch to ON.
• For 2-wire communication
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the switch No.2 and No.3 to ON.
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the switch No.5 and No.6 to ON.
• For 4-wire communication
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the switch No.2 and No.3 to OFF.
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the switch No.5 and No.6 to OFF.
I RS485 Port
Internal block diagram
RA
RB
DATA
TA
TB
G
N
D
G
N
D
TA TB RA RB
Output Input
82
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM/CONTROL Connector
These terminals are used for emergency recording, auto time adjustment (Auto Adjust Time), taking measures against power
outages (Shutdown Time), and when installing a buzzer, a lamp, or similar alarm device. They are also used to synchronize
with the sequential display changeover.
The terminal pin array and connections are shown below. The
connector used should be compatible with the pin configuration.
!
q
Pin array
ALARM/CONTOROL
The pin array is different from other disk recorders. Make sure that
the connection is correct referring to the following.
@
!
Pin No.
Signal
Operation
Remarks
Ch 8 alarm output
Ch 9 alarm output
Ch 10 alarm output
Ch 11 alarm output
Ch 12 alarm output
Ch 13 alarm output
Ch 14 alarm output
Ch 15 alarm output
Ch 16 alarm output
NC
q
w
e
r
t
y
u
i
o
!
!
Alarm signal output at an event occurrence
Open collector output
24 V max., 100 mA
Only for the WJ-HD316
(Not available for the WJ-HD309)
Alarm reset input
Canceling the alarm display
Non-voltage make contact input
–100 mA, 5 V pull-up
Emergency recording
input
Starting emergency recording disk space a sig-
nal input
!
Earth (Grounding)
!, !
Alarm output for available
disk space of device con-
nected to copy port
Generation of signal output for disk space alarm- Open collector output
!
ing of DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R
24 V max., 100 mA
Signal output upon detection of an HDD error
Signal output upon detection of a camera error
Signal output upon detection of a unit error
HDD error output
Camera error output
Error output
!
!
!
End of outage process-
ing
Signal output upon completion of outage pro-
cessing
High (+12 V)
!
The time of this unit is adjusted to the preset time
30 kΩ 5 V pull-up,
according to the signal input. This signal output is –100 mA/make contact
then generated for the setting time of this unit.
Time of all other units is adjusted to the setting
time of this unit.
Time adjustment I/O
@
Sequence changeover is affected according to
the signal input. Signal output is generated at the
time of sequence changeover.
Sequence changeover
I/O
@
The state of alarm suspension is assumed
according to the signal input.
Alarm suspension input
Outage detection I/O
@
@
Start of outage processing according to the sig-
nal input.
Non-voltage make contact input
–100 mA/5 V pull-up
External recording mode
changeover
Changeover to the external recording mode
+5 V output
@
@
+5 V output
200 mA max.
83
ꢀ Connection for emergency recording
When the external switch is turned ON, emergency recording will be started.
Resolution, recording time, recording rate and quality for emergency recording can differ according to the settings of
"Emergency REC" of "Recording" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 99.)
(Earth)
(Emergency record input)
!
!
External switch
ALARM/CONTOROL
ꢀ Connection for external recording changeover
When the external switch is turned ON, the recording program changeover is affected for recording.
The recording program can be set for "EXT." with the "Time Table" of "Schedule" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 108.)
(Earth)
(External recording mode)
!
@
External switch
ALARM/CONTOROL
ꢀ Connection to synchronize the sequential display changeover (when multiple
units are used)
Sequential display changeover is affected by the timing of supplied signals to the sequence changeover input terminal. When
multiple units are used, the sequence timing can be synchronized.
Setting for the sequence timing can be set with "Sequence Timing" of "Switcher" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 111.)
For the synchronization of the sequence timing between multiple units, there is a difference in the sequence timing setting as
shown below between the synchronized side (Master) and the synchronizing side (Slave).
Synchronized side (Master): Set at "INT" (functioning as an output terminal)
Synchronizing side (Slave): Set at "EXT" (functioning as an input terminal)
(Earth)
(Earth)
(Sequence changeover input)
(Sequence changeover output)
!
!
@
@
ALARM/CONTOROL
ALARM/CONTOROL
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
(First unit)
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
(Second unit)
84
ꢀ Connection for the Auto Adjust Time function
• When "Auto Adjust Time" of "System" on the SETUP MENU is set to "MASTER"
"Time Adjust Output" becomes available and the clock of this unit can be applied to other units.
Terminal block of other units
Front LED
(Earth)
(Time adjust output)
monitor
output
!
@
ALARM/CONTOROL
• When "Auto Adjust Time" of "System" on the SETUP MENU is set to "SLAVE"
"Time Adjust Input" becomes available. When a signal output from other equipment is supplied to the time adjust I/O terminals
between 00 minutes 00 seconds and 14 minutes 59 seconds every hour or between 45 minutes 00 seconds and 59 minutes
59 seconds every hour, the clock will be set to "00 minutes 00 seconds" of the closest hour.
Example:
Signal is supplied at 2:50:00 (hour:minute:second)pm → Set at 3:00:00 pmM
Signal input supplied at 3:14:45 pm → Set at 3:00:00 pm
Signal is supplied at 3:20:00 pm → Time will not be adjusted.
Terminal block of other units
Front LED
(Earth)
(Time adjust output)
monitor
output
!
@
ALARM/CONTOROL
Important:
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds when changing the present time (accurate within 5 seconds) using
the time adjustment input (pin no.20).
85
ꢀ Connection with the Uninterruptible Power System (UPS)
This is an example of connection with the uninterruptible power system (UPS) to be installed to protect from a power outage.
When a signal is supplied to the outage detection I/O terminals from the uninterruptible power system (UPS), internal process-
ing (stops recording safely) will be started to shut off the power supply for this unit.
After completing the internal processing, a signal will be supplied from the outage processing end output terminal to the unin-
terruptible power system (UPS). Then, the power supply to this unit can be suspended.
(GND)
(C O M )
(Detection)
(Shutdown)
(Outage detection I/O)
(Outage processing end output)
* Refer to the operating
instructions of the used
product for further
This unit
information about
connection of the UPS side.
!
@
!
Uninterruptible
power system
(UPS)
Power cable
To an AC outlet
ALARM/CONTOROL
ꢀ Connection of the control output
• When an alarm device such as a buzzer or a lamp is connected, the signal output from Pin Nos. 15 - 18 can be used to
notify the status by sounding a buzzer or lighting a lamp.
• The following example is of a connection with the HDD error output (pin no. 16).
(GND)
(HDD error output)
!
!
Alarming device
Relay, etc.
Install according
to your needs
ALARM/CONTOROL
86
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM Connector
These terminals are used to connect the alarm devices, such as sensors, door switches, etc.
The pin configurations of these terminals are as shown below. The connector used should be compatible with the pin configu-
ration.
Pin Configuration
!
q
ALARM
@
!
The pin array is different from other disk recorders. Make sure that the connection is correct by referring to the following.
Pin No.
q
Signal
Ch 1 alarm input
Ch 2 alarm input
Ch 3 alarm input
Ch 4 alarm input
Ch 5 alarm input
Ch 6 alarm input
Ch 7 alarm input
Ch 8 alarm input
Ch 1 alarm output
Ch 2 alarm output
Ch 3 alarm output
Ch 4 alarm output
Earth (Grounding)
Ch 9 alarm input
Ch 10 alarm input
Ch 11 alarm input
Ch 12 alarm input
Ch 13 alarm input
Ch 14 alarm input
Ch 15 alarm input
Ch 16 alarm input
Ch 5 alarm output
Ch 6 alarm output
Ch 7 alarm output
Operation
Remarks
Event action will be performed according
to the settings.
Non-voltage make contact/–100 mA,
w
5 V pull-up
e
r
t
y
u
i
o
Alarm signal will be supplied at an event
occurrence
Open collector output/24 V, 100 mA
!
!
!
!, !
!
Event action will be performed according
to the setting.
Non-voltage make contact input/
–100 mA, 5 V pull-up
!
!
!
Only for the WJ-HD316
(Not available for the WJ-HD309)
!
@
@
@
@
Alarm signal will be supplied at an event
occurrence
Open collector output/24 V max.,
100 mA
@
@
87
ꢀ Alarm connection
When a signal is supplied to the alarm input terminals of CH 1-16, recording and displaying of camera images will be per-
formed according to the settings.
When an alarm device such as a buzzer, a lamp, etc., is installed outside, connect them to the alarm output terminals (pin nos.
9 - 12, pin nos. 23 - 25) or to the alarm output terminals (pin nos. 1 - 9) of the ALARM/CONTROL terminal.
Sensor
Security door
switch
(GND)
!
o
!
q
Alarming devices
Relay, etc.
@
Install according to
your needs.
ALARM
(Ch 1 alarm output)
(GND)
!
o
Alarming devices
Relay, etc.
ALARM/CONTOROL
Install according to
your needs.
(Ch 16 alarm output)
Time and polarities of the ALARM/CONTROL terminal and the ALARM terminal
Terminal
Active time
Note
Alarm input
100 ms or more
N.O.: L active
N.C.: H active
Alarm output
The set time on the SETUP MENU
100 ms or more
L active
L active
L active
L active
Alarm reset input
Emergency recording input
100 ms or more
Alarm output for available disk space of While the size of the available disk
device connected to the copy port
space is less than the set size
Until the HDD error is cleared
Until the camera error is cleared
Until the error is cleared
100 ms
HDD error output
L active
L active
L active
H active
L active
Camera error output
Error output
Outage processing end output
Time adjust I/O
Input: 100 ms or more
Output: 1 s
Sequence changeover output
Outage detection output
100 ms or more
100 ms or more
100 ms or more
100 ms or more
L active
L active
External recording mode changeover
Alarm suspend output
L active, judged by level
L active, judged by level
88
I How to Use the SERIAL Connector
This connector is compliant with the RS232C Standard, and is used to communicate with a connected PC.
A connection example and the pin configuration of the SERIAL connector are as shown below.
Important:
• When using the SERIAL connector, it is necessary to perform the settings with "RS232C Setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP
MENU for the communication functions. (Page 118)
ꢀ Pin Configuration
Serial connector of this unit
D-sub Pin 9 (Female)
Personal computer side
D-sub Pin 9 (Female)
(Locally procured)
7 (RTS)
7 (RTS)
8 (CTS)
3 (TXD)
5 (GND)
2 (RXD)
8 (CTS)
3 (TXD)
5 (GND)
2 (RXD)
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
PC or another device
Connection example of cross cable
ꢀ Connection example
D-sub Pin 9
(Female)
D-sub Pin 9
(Female)
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
2
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
15
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
PC
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
This unit
89
SETUP
To operate this unit, it is necessary to set each item of the SETUP MENU in advance.
Perform the settings for each item of the SETUP MENU by displaying the SETUP MENU on monitor 2.
Settings items are as below.
I Item list of the SETUP MENU
Settings menu
Maintenance
Description
Page
REC Rate
Display the recording rate for each recording mode and image quality for each
camera channel in list form.
94
94
94
95
95
95
Disk Info
Display hard disk information such as the available disk space on the built-in hard
disk and the connected optional extension unit.
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
Display version information of the software and the hardware and the MAC
address.
Set actions to be taken when the available space of the built-in hard disk or of the
connected external recording device reaches a specified level.
Set to display a warning when the available space of the built-in hard disk or of the
connected external recording device reaches a specified level.
Delete data stored on the hard disk, or format (initialize) the DVD-RAM disk con-
nected to the COPY port.
Event Log
Error Log
Display the event log. Refer to page 44 for further information.
Display the error log such as a HDD error log.
96
96
97
Access Log
Display the time, user name and IP addresses when logging in/out to/from this
unit.
Recording
REC Setup
Perform the basic settings for recording.
98
99
Emergency REC
Perform the settings for emergency recording such as recording time and record-
ing rate.
Event
Event Setup
Perform the settings for the alarm output duration and the buzzer sound when an
event (motion detection, video loss, command/terminal alarm) occurs.
100
100
VMD Setup
Perform the settings for the motion detection area, sensitivity and the detection
mode for each camera channel.
Alarm Setup
Perform the settings for the alarm display duration and alarm suspension duration.
Specify the alarm terminal polarity.
103
104
Terminal Setup
Schedule
Time Table
Create timetables for each day of the week, and assign the recording action pro-
grams and event action programs to the created timetables.
108
REC Program
Up to 4 recording programs can be created. Perform the settings for the recording
actions for each program such as image quality and recording rate for each cam-
era channel.
105
107
109
Event Program
Special Days
Up to 4 event programs can be created. Perform the settings for each program
such as the event action and the auto copy function for each event type.
Assign timetables independently for special days aside from other days.
90
Description
Page
Settings menu
Switcher
Monitor1
Perform the settings for the image switching on monitor 1 such as the setting of
the sequential display or the screen to be displayed at login on monitor 1.
110
112
Monitor 2
Display
Perform the settings for the image switching on monitor 2 such as the setting of
the sequential display or the screen to be displayed at login on monitor 2.
OSD Setup
Monitor1
Monitor2
Perform the display settings such as the settings for the display position of the
camera title and the time.
113
114
115
Perform the display settings for monitor 1 such as the camera title display on/off,
the alarm display on/off and the time display on/off.
Perform the display settings for monitor 2 such as the display mode (task bar
style), the camera title display position, and the camera title display on/off.
Comm
Camera Control
Set the communication type to control cameras for each camera channel.
116
116
PS·Data Setup
Perform the settings for the PS·Data. It is necessary to perform these settings
when connecting an external device such as a controller to the DATA port on the
rear panel of this unit.
RS485 Setup
RS232C Setup
NW Setup 1
NW Setup 2
NTP Setup
Perform the settings for the RS485. It is necessary to perform these settings when
connecting an RS 485 compatible camera to the RS485 (CAMERA) port on the
rear panel of this unit.
117
118
119
Perform the settings for the SERIAL (RS232C). It is necessary to perform these
settings when connecting a PC to the SERIAL connector on the rear panel of this
unit.
Perform the basic network settings. It is necessary to perform these settings when
operating this unit via a network such as a LAN. The settings for the user authenti-
cation and the host authentication can also be set with these settings.
Perform the network connection settings such as IP addresses and the gateway
address. It is necessary to perform these settings when operating this unit via a
network such as a LAN.
119
120
Perform the NTP server settings such as the NTP server address and the time
zone setting. It is necessary to synchronize the clock with the NTP server.
System
Basic Setup
Time & Date
User Regist.
Perform the settings for the basic operation of this unit.
121
122
123
Perform the settings for the time adjustment and display of the time and date.
Perform the settings for the user registration and the user authentication such as
user name, password and operational level.
User Edit
Edit the registered user information.
Delete registered users.
124
124
124
User Delete
Host Regist.
Register the hosts (PCs access this unit via a network) with their information such
as IP address and operational level for the host authentication.
Host Edit
Edit the registered hosts.
125
125
125
126
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
Delete the registered hosts.
Perform the settings to specify operable functions for each level.
The set contents can be saved or loaded.
Note: Refer to page 127 for further information about the settings using the setup menu of camera.
91
I About the SETUP MENU
Main menu
Live image
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Switcher
Display
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM 1
CAM 2
CAM 3
CAM 4
CAM 5
CAM 6
CAM 7
CAM 8
CAM 9
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
Main area
Submenu
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
Main menu: These menus are always displayed on the SETUP MENU.
Live image: Live images from the camera channel that was selected just before the SETUP MENU was displayed.
Main area: The setting items of the selected submenu will be displayed in this area.
Submenu: The submenu of the selected main menu will be displayed on the left side of the SETUP MENU. The submenus dif-
fer depending on the selected main menu.
Notes:
• The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP MENU on
monitor 1.)
• The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be displayed on the VGA monitor.
• Depending on the connected monitor, flickering may occur when displaying the SETUP MENU. In this case, it is recom-
mended to use the VGA monitor or a dirtectly connected PC using a LAN cable to perform the settings. (Refer to the
Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for descriptions of how to connect this unit and a PC directly.)
92
I Basic Operation with the SETUP MENU
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or more
v Perform the settings for each item.
when displaying live images.
Item selection: Move the cursor using the arrows but-
ton (C D A B).
[Screenshot 1]
Change the setting: Rotate the jog dial.
The top page of the SETUP MENU will be displayed.
Pop-up display of the setting item: Press the SET but-
ton when the setting item has the "SETUP" button
next to the item name.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
Turning pages of the settings menu: When "PREV/
NEXT PAGE" is displayed on the bottom of the set-
tings menu, move the cursor to the "PREV/NEXT
PAGE" using the arrows button, and then use the
arrows button (AB) to turn the pages.
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Selecting a submenu again: Press the SET button.
The cursor will be able to select a submenu again.
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
x Select a main menu using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
b After completing the settings, press the SETUP/ESC
button for 2 seconds or more to apply the settings. The
SETUP MENU will be closed.
[Screenshot 2]
The submenu of the selected main menu will be displayed.
→ Live images will be displayed again.
Important:
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
If the settings are changed, all login users will be
forcibly logged out.
ON
OFF
All
REC Setup
Recording
Power ON Manual REC
Manual Recording Channel
Embedded REC(Title)
Embedded REC(Time&Date)
I
I
I
I
I
I
Emergency REC
ON
ON
REC Priority
PRIORITY
REC MODE
Manual REC
Event REC
1
2
3
Schedule REC
Audio Allocation
AUDIO
I
CAMERA
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
Audio1
Audio2
Audio3
Audio4
c Select the submenu using the arrows button (CD) and
the press the SET button.
When selecting the submenu by the cursor is enabled,
press the SETUP/ESC button. The main menu can be
selected.
[Screenshot 3]
The setting items will be displayed in the main area and the
cursor will move to a setting item.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
REC Setup
Resolution
Recording Time
Recording Rate and Quality
FIELD
10s
I
I
I
Emergency REC
RATE
Quality
RATE
Quality
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
SFA CAM9
SFA CAM10
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
CAM11
SFA
SFA CAM12
SFA CAM13
SFA CAM14
SFA CAM15
SFA CAM16
Auto Copy
OFF
I
93
I [Maintenance] Functions for Maintaining
Perform the settings for the hard disk drives.
It is possible to check the histories (log) of event occur-
rence, error occurrence and access.
Notes:
• The displayed available disk space on this menu
will not include the space required for data man-
agement. Therefore, the understated available disk
space will be displayed.
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
• When CONTINUE is selected for "Disk End Mode" of
"Maintenance", available disk space will be dis-
played as "--".
• "**" will be displayed to refer to a disk that is not
connected or a non-existent area on the disk.
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
8Warning for Disk Life Time (hour meter warning
setting)
Select the duration as the maximum active time of the hard
disk from the following. A warning will be displayed when
the set time have passed. Hard disk drives will need to be
replaced after around 20 000 - 30 000 hours of operation in
case they are used at temperature of 25°C (77 °F). (Refer to
page 5.)
ꢀ [REC Rate] Check the recording rate and
the image quality for each camera channel.
The recording rate for each recording mode for each cam-
era (as shown below) will be displayed in list form.
10 000 h/20 000 h/30 000 h
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording
Switcher Display
Event
Schedule
System
LIVE
Comm
MANU
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR
REC Rate
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
CAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
8HDD Safety Mode
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Date Delete
When maintaining (HDD replacement, installation, etc.)
without turning the power of the unit off, select ON for "HDD
Safety Mode". The unit will be restarted in the HDD Safety
Mode. Refer to page 68 for further information.
(The default setting is ON.)
CAM 10
CAM 11
CAM 12
CAM 13
CAM 14
CAM 15
CAM 16
Event Log
Error Log
SUPER FINE
FINE
Access Log
NORMAL
EXTENDED
MANU: Manual recording
SCHE: Schedule recording
PRE EVT: Pre-event recording
POST EVT: Post-event recording
EMR: Emergency recording
ꢀ [Version Info] Check the version information
Version information of the software and the hardware, and
the MAC address will be displayed.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
REC Rate
ꢀ [Disk Info] Check the available hard disk
Software
Hardware (M)
(V)
Mac Address
V1.00
V1.00
V1.00
I
Disk Info
I
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
AA-BB-CC-DD-EE-FF
space
I
The available hard disk space of the following will be dis-
played: The built-in hard disk (normal recording area, event
recording area and copy area), optional extension unit
(EXT1 - 7), DVD-RAM, CD-R and DVD-R disk drive connect-
ed to the copy port (COPY1 or COPY2).
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
Refer to page 25 for more details on the built-in hard disk.
It is also possible to perform the settings for the hour-meter
(the active time of the HDD) warning and for the HDD safety
mode with this menu.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
1
2
3
4
REC Rate
Remaining
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
MAIN
EXT1
EXT2
EXT3
EXT4
EXT5
EXT6
EXT7
Normal REC Area
Event REC Area
Copy Area
1800GB
Disk Info
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
160GB
15000h
1200GB
1000GB
1000GB
1000GB
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
COPY 1 (Rear)
COPY 2 (Front)
Event Log
Error Log
Warning for Disk Life Time
HDD Safety Mode
3000h
OFF
I
I
Access Log
94
Important:
When "CONTINUE" is selected for "Disk End Mode", a
ꢀ [Disk End Mode] Set actions to be taken
when the available hard disk space has run
out
warning will not be issued.
Select an action from the following to be taken when the
available space of the built-in hard disk (normal recording
area, event recording area, copy area) or the external
recording device (DVD-RAM, CD-R or DVD-R disk drive)
connected to the copy port (COPY1, COPY2) is running
out.
ꢀ [Data Delete] Delete image data on the hard
disk
Delete image data on the built-in hard disk (normal record-
ing area/event recording area).
Auto deletion and manual deletion are available to delete
image data.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
It is also possible to initialize (format) a DVD-RAM disk with
this menu.
HDD
REC Rate
I
Normal Recording Area
Event Recording Area
Copy Area
COPY1
COPY2
CONTINUE
CONTINUE
STOP
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
STOP
I
I
STOP
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Event Log
Error Log
Auto Delete
REC Rate
I
I
OFF
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Delete before 01 JAN 03
DELETE
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
Delete before 01
Disc Format of DVD
Disk Info
.
.
Access Log
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
.
JAN
DELETE
.
03
COPY1
FORMAT
FORMAT
COPY2
Event Log
Error Log
CONTINUE: When the available disk space has run out, the
older data will be overwritten by the newer data. In this
case, the oldest data is the first to be overwritten.
STOP: When the available disk space has run out, record-
ing and copying will be canceled.
Access Log
8Auto Delete
It is possible to delete recorded images automatically when
the set number of days has passed from the day the image
was recorded. Refer to a system administrator for further
information.
The number of days for the auto delete function is as fol-
lows.
Important:
When changing the setting from CONTINUE to STOP
during overwriting, the oldest 1 hour’s worth of record-
ed images will be deleted. It is impossible to recover
the deleted images even if it is set to CONTINUE again.
The auto delete function will not work when OFF is selected.
OFF/1DAY/2DAYS/3DAYS/4DAYS/5DAYS/6DAYS/7DAYS/
8DAYS/9DAYS/10DAYS/14DAYS/30DAYS/45DAYS/
60DAYS/90DAYS/120DAYS/150DAYS/180DAYS
Note: When copying on a CD-R or DVD-R disk, copying will
stop automatically when the available disk space has
run out even though CONTINUE is selected.
Note: Images recorded on the HDD copy area will not be
ꢀ [Disk Capacity] Set actions to be taken when
deleted.
the available disk space is running out
8Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area
Select an action from the following to be taken when the
available space of the built-in hard disk (normal recording
area, event recording area, copy area) or the external
recording device (DVD-RAM, CD-R or DVD-R disk drive)
connected to the copy port (COPY1, COPY2) reaches a
specified level.
By setting the time and date, images in the normal record-
ing area of the hard disk that were recorded up until a day
before the set time and date will be deleted.
Enter a 2-digit number for the year when entering the time
and date.
The setting range is between 1 % and 10 % (in 1 % inter-
vals).
The warning will not be issued when OFF is selected.
8Manual Delete for Event Recording Area
By setting the time and date, images in the event recording
area of the hard disk that were recorded up until a day
before the set time and date will be deleted.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
HDD Capacity Warning
REC Rate
I
Normal Recording Area
Event Recording Area
Copy Area
COPY1 Capacity Warning
COPY2 Capacity Warning
OFF
10
10
10
10
Disk Info
8Disc Format of DVD
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
I
I
Initialize (format) a DVD-RAM disk in the DVD-RAM drive
connected to the copy port.
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
95
ꢀ [Event Log] Check the event log
ꢀ [Error Log] Check the error log
The event log (time and date at an event occurrence,
details) will be displayed in list form.
The error log will be displayed in list form.
Refer to page 45 for further information about each event.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
No.
Time&Date
Event
REC Rate
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM H.METER MAIN1-1
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM AL 1-0312312359
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM R-ERR EXT1-2
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM CAM LOSS1
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM PWR RECOVER
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:11 PM H.METER MAIN1-1
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM AL1-0312312359
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:11 PM R-ERR EXT1-2
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM CAM LOSS1
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM PWR RECOVER
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM H.METER MAIN1-1
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM AL1-0312312359
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:00 PM R-ERR EXT1-2
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM COM LOSS1
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM PWR RECOVER
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM H.METER MAIN1-1
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM AL1-0312312359
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM R-ERR EXT1-2
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM COM LOSS1
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM PWR RECOVER
Disk Info
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
LIVE
No.
Time&Date
Event
REC Rate Status
Disk Info
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:11 PM
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:11 PM
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:00 PM
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM
LOSS16
TRM-1
VMD-14
EMR
COM-13
LOSS-15
TRM-12
VMD-4
EMR
COM-8
LOSS-16
TRM-1
VMD-14
EMR
COM-13
LOSS-15
TRM-12
VMD-4
EMR
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
PREV/NEXT PAGE
Event Log
Error Log
Access Log
COM-8
PREV/NEXT PAGE
Note: Up to 100 error logs can be kept. When more than
100 error logs are filed, the older error logs will be over-
written by the newer error logs. In this case, the oldest
log is the first to be overwritten.
COM: Command alarm
EMR: Emergency recording
LOSS: Video loss
TRM: Terminal alarm
VMD: Motion detection
Note: Up to 750 event logs can be kept. When more than
750 event logs are filed, the older event logs will be
overwritten by the newer event logs. In this case, the
oldest log is the first to be overwritten.
Indication
Description
Cause
AL*-YYMMDDhhmmss
Asterisk (*) indicates the camera channel Detects alteration
number
YYDDMMhhmmss indicates the played
time when the alteration was detected.
W-ERR X-Y
X indicates the unit/unit number that has
the hard disk error
Y indicates the disk number in the unit
(unit number)
Failed to write data on the HDD
Auto removal of the link
REMOVE X-Y
X indicates the unit/unit number that has
the hard disk that has been removed
from the subject for recording.
Y indicates the disk number in the
unit/unit number
#-FULL
# indicates the partition name/external
recording device port number
No available disk space
THERMAL -X
FAN X-Y
X indicates the unit/unit number in which Thermal error
the thermal error occurred
X indicates the unit/unit number
Y indicates the fan number (1-4)
Y will be left out if the malfunctioning fan
is in the extension unit
The fan is malfunctioning
#-nn%
# indicates the partition name of the hard Warning that the disk space is running
disk/external recording device
out
nn indicates the available disk space
96
Indication
Description
Cause
HDD SMART error
SMART X-Y
PWR LOSS
H.METER X-Y
X indicates the unit/unit number that has
the hard disk error
Y indicates the unit/unit number
Detects a power outage
Hour-meter warning
X indicates the unit/unit number that has
the hard disk error
Y indicates the unit/unit number
PROTECT -#
NO DISK -#
MEDIUM -#
# indicates the port number to which the
external recording device is connected
Disk has a write protection
Disk is not inserted
Incompatible disk
# indicates the port number to which the
external recording device is connected
# indicates the port number to which the
external recording device is connected
UNFORMATTED -#
W-ERR (MEDIUM-#)
PWR RECOVER
# indicates the port number to which the
external recording device is connected
Unformatted disk
# indicates the port number to which the
external recording device is connected
Failed to write data on the disk (CD-R,
DVD-RAM and DVD-R)
Recover from a power outage
Notes:
ꢀ [Access Log] Check the access log
• Up to 100 access logs can be kept. When more than
100 access logs are filed, the older access logs will be
overwritten by the newer access logs. In this case, the
oldest log is the first to be overwritten.
The time, user name and IP addresses when logging in/out
to/from this unit will be displayed in list form.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
• Logs of accesses via an FTP will not be displayed.
REC Rate
No.
Time&Date
Event
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM 192.168.100.100 IN
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM tshimi IN
Disk Info
Version Info
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM tshimi OUT
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:00 PM 192.168.100.100 IN
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:23 PM tshimi IN
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM tshimi OUT
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM 192.168 100.100 IN
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:11 PM tshimi IN
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM tshimi OUT
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM 192.168.100.100 IN
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM tshimi IN
Event Log
Error Log
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM tshimi OUT
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT
Access Log
PREV/NEXT PAGE
**IN: The user name or the IP address displayed before IN
indicates the user/host logged in.
**OUT: The user name or the IP address displayed before
OUT indicates the user/host logged out.
**: A user name or host name will be displayed.
97
I [Recording]
Perform the settings for the basic recording (REC Setup)
and the emergency recording.
Important:
When operating on monitor 1 when "MON2" is selected
for "Manual Recording Channel" on the "REC Setup"
menu, all camera channels will be recorded by manual
recording instead of recording the camera channel dis-
played on monitor 2.
When "MON2" is selected, images from a camera chan-
nel for another manual recording that has started later
will be recorded regardless of the operation using the
buttons on the front panel or via a network.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
ON
OFF
All
REC Setup
Recording
Power ON Manual REC
Manual Recording Channel
Embedded REC(Title)
Embedded REC(Time&Date)
I
I
I
I
I
I
Emergency REC
ON
ON
REC Priority
PRIORITY
REC MODE
Manual REC
Event REC
1
2
3
Schedule REC
Audio Allocation
AUDIO
I
CAMERA
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
Audio1
Audio2
Audio3
Audio4
8Embedded REC (Title)
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to record a
displayed camera title together as a part of the recorded
image.
ꢀ [REC Setup] Perform the settings for the
basic recording.
ON: Record camera titles together as a part of the record-
ed image.
Perform the following settings for the basic recording.
OFF: Does not record camera titles.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
ON
OFF
All
REC Setup
Recording
Power ON Manual REC
Manual Recording Channel
Embedded REC(Title)
Embedded REC(Time&Date)
I
I
I
I
I
I
8Embedded REC (Time & Date)
Emergency REC
ON
ON
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to record the
displayed time and date together.
ON: Record the time and date together as a part of the
recorded image.
REC Priority
PRIORITY
REC MODE
Manual REC
Event REC
1
2
3
Schedule REC
Audio Allocation
AUDIO
I
CAMERA
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
Audio1
Audio2
Audio3
Audio4
OFF: Does not record the time and date.
8Recording
Important:
• It is possible to select ON or OFF to determine whether
or not to display the camera title during playback even
though OFF is selected. (Refer to pages 114, 115.)
• When ON is selected, it is impossible to hide the cam-
era title and the time and date. (Refer to pages 114,
115.)
Select ON or OFF to record or not record.
ON: Recording will be performed.
OFF: No recording will be performed.
Important:
When OFF is selected for this setting, no recording will
be performed. Select ON for normal use except when it
is necessary to stop recording forcibly such as when a
problem has occurred with the unit.
8REC Priority
Assigns priorities to recording modes. Assigns priorities 1
(highest) - 3 (lowest) to each recording mode. When two or
more recordings are performed in the same period, only a
recording with the highest priority will be performed.
Refer to page 19 for further information about each record-
ing mode.
8Power ON Manual REC
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to start
recording when the power is turned on by the connected
external timer (or the switch).
ON: Manual recording will start automatically after complet-
ing the system check.
OFF: Manual recording will not start automatically after
completing the system check.
Important:
The priority of event recording will be applied for the
priority of pre-/post-event recording. When pre-/post-
event recording is to be performed, it is impossible to
perform manual recording/schedule recording.
Important:
When ON is selected, manual recording will start auto-
matically after completing the system check.
8Audio Allocation
Allocates audio from the audio input connectors (1 - 4) on
the rear panel of the unit to camera channels.
Allocate audio in accordance with the channels of the con-
nected cameras. When OFF is selected, audio will not be
heard.
8Manual Recording Channel
Select a camera channel for manual recording from the fol-
lowing. Refer to page 19 for manual recording.
MON2: Images from the camera channel currently dis-
played on monitor 2 will be recorded.
ALL: Images from all the camera channels will be record-
ed.
98
Important:
MANUAL: Recording will continue while the external switch
is being held down.
CONTINUE: Recording will not stop until the ALARM
RESET button on the front panel of the unit is pressed.
• When a live image from the audio assigned camera
channel is displayed on a single screen on monitor 2,
audio will be heard. When displaying on a multi-screen,
audio will not be heard.
• When images from the audio assigned camera channel
are displayed on a single screen, recorded audio will
be heard. When displaying on a multi-screen, recorded
audio will not be heard.
• Audio will be recorded regardless of whether you are
displaying on a single screen or a multi-screen.
• Audio may be recorded fragmentary occasionally.
8Recording Rate and Quality
Perform the settings for the recording rate and image quali-
ty for emergency recording.
The following are available for the recording rate.
OFF/1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/
12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips
Important:
• When OFF is selected for a specified camera channel,
images from a camera channel set to OFF will not be
recorded.
ꢀ [Emergency REC] Perform the settings for
emergency recording
• When "FRAME 3D ON" or "FRAME 3D OFF" is selected,
the total recording rates of CAM 1 - CAM 16 (for the
WJ-HD316) must be less than 25 ips.
• When "FIELD" is selected, the total recording rates of
CAM 1 - CAM 16 (for the WJ-HD316) must be less than
50 ips.
Perform the settings for emergency recording such as the
recording time or recording rate for emergency recording.
Refer to page 21 for further information about emergency
recording.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
• When "SIF" is selected, the total recording rates of CAM
1 - CAM 16 (for the WJ-HD316) must be less than
100 ips.
• When "FRAME 3D ON", "FRAME 3D OFF" or "SIF" is
selected, it is impossible to select 50 ips.
REC Setup
Resolution
Recording Time
Recording Rate and Quality
FIELD
10s
I
I
I
Emergency REC
RATE
Quality
RATE
Quality
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
2.5ips
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
SFA CAM9
SFA CAM10
SFA
SFA CAM12
SFA CAM13
SFA CAM14
SFA CAM15
SFA CAM16
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
CAM11
Auto Copy
OFF
I
The following are available for the image quality.
SFA/SFB: Top quality (SUPER FINE)
FQA/FQB: High quality (FINE)
NQA/NQB: Standard quality (NORMAL)
EXA/EXB: Low quality (EXTENDED)
8Resolution
Select a recording resolution from the following.
FRAME 3D ON: High resolution (720 x 576), with camera
shake compensation
FRAME 3D OFF: High resolution (720 x 576)
FIELD: Standard resolution (720 x 288)
SIF: Low resolution (360 x 288)
**A is suitable for less dynamic images.
**B is suitable for more dynamic images.
Important:
When "B/W" is selected for the colour mode, do not
select "SFA", "FQA", "NQA" or "EXA" for the image quali-
ty. Otherwise, the image quality may become poor.
(The colour mode setting is available only using a PC
via a network.)
Important:
• It is recommended to set the same value for the resolu-
tion of emergency recording as the resolution of manual
recording, event recording and schedule recording.
• Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds
from the beginning of emergency recording when the
resolution is switched.
8Auto Copy
Select ON or OFF to set whether or not to automatically
copy images recorded by emergency recording onto the
copy area on the built-in hard disk or DVD-RAM disk.
• Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds
just after emergency recording has finished.
Important:
8Recording Time
When OFF is selected for "Auto Copy" on "Basic setup"
of "System", the auto copy function will not work after
emergency recording even though ON is selected for
this setting. Select "HDD", "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" for
"Auto Copy".
Perform the settings for the recording time and recording
action for emergency recording.
The following are available for the recording time.
1 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)
20 s/30 s
1 m - 10 m (in 1 minute intervals)
20 m/30 m/40 m/50 m/60 m
99
I [Event] Function for Events
Perform the settings for event actions of each event type
(motion detection, video loss, command alarm and terminal
alarm).
The following are available for the buzzer sound duration.
When OFF is selected, a buzzer will not sound.
(s: second, m: minute)
OFF: The buzzer will not sound.
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m
EXT: The buzzer will continue until the ALARM RESET but-
ton is pressed.
Event Setup
VMD Setup
VMD
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
I
I
I
Video Loss
Terminal/Command Alarm
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
ꢀ [VMD Setup] Perform the settings for the
motion detection function
Select ON or OFF to determine whether to enable or dis-
able the motion detection function for each camera chan-
nel.
When ON is selected, perform the settings for the motion
detection area for each camera channel. Up to 4 areas can
be set for a camera channel for the detection area. Refer to
page 45 for further information about the motion detection
function.
ꢀ [Event Setup] Settings for the alarm output
duration and the buzzer duration
Perform the settings for the alarm output duration and the
buzzer sound duration for each event type (motion detec-
tion, video loss, command alarm and terminal alarm).
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Event Setup
VMD Setup
VMD
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
I
I
I
Video Loss
Terminal/Command Alarm
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM9
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
ON
Event Setup
VMD Setup
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Event Setup
VMD Setup
VMD
SETUP
SETUP
P
I
I
Video Loss Setup
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
Alarm Output
Buzzer
I
I
1 0 s
1 0 s
O K
CANCEL
The following are available for the alarm output duration.
When OFF is selected, the alarm output will not be sup-
plied.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the camera channel selection menu of
the "VMD Setup" window.
(s: second, m: minute)
OFF: No alarm output is supplied.
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)
/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m
EXT: Alarm output will continue until the ALARM RESET
button is pressed.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM9
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
ON
Event Setup
VMD Setup
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
Important:
The alarm output duration cannot be set for video loss.
Signals will be supplied continuously from the camera
error output terminal (pin no. 17) of the ALARM/CON-
TROL connector on the rear panel during the period
when the video signal is lost. (Refer to page 83.)
z Rotate the jog dial to select ON for a desired camera
channel for which the motion detection function is to be
applied, and press the SET button.
100
[Screenshot 2]
[Screenshot 5]
The "VMD Setup" window will be displayed.
The motion detection area is set with the start point and the
end point as the points at opposite angles of the motion
detection area.
x Rotate the jog dial to select "SETUP AREA" on the status
bar.
Note: To set all areas on the monitor as the motion
detection area, select "ALL AREAS" and press the
SET button.
b Repeat steps 3 and 4 to set another motion detection
area.
Up to 4 areas can be set. The newly created areas will
be named automatically as A, B, C and D in the order of
creation.
[Screenshot 3]
The cross cursor will be displayed on the "VMD Setup" win-
dow.
n To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.
→ The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.
ꢀ Delete the motion detection area
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.
c Move the cross cursor to a desired point to be set as
the start point of the motion detection area using the
arrows button, and press the SET button.
[Screenshot 4]
The start point of the motion detection area is assigned.
z Rotate the jog dial to select "DELETE AREA" on the sta-
tus bar.
Note: After selecting "DELETE ALL AREAS", pressing
the SET button will delete all of the motion detection
areas.
[Screenshot 2]
The cross cursor will be displayed on the "VMD Setup" win-
dow.
v Move the cross cursor to a desired point to be set as
the end point of the motion detection area using the
arrows button, and press the SET button.
101
x Move the cross cursor onto an area to be deleted using
8Set the detection mode
the arrows button and press the SET button.
Perform the settings of the detection mode (method of
detection) in the set detection area. Specifying a method of
detection in a detection area is available by setting the
detection mode.
c To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select
"EXIT" on the status bar.
→ The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.
8Set the sensitivity
Set the sensitivity for the created motion detection area.
Sensitivity can be set for each area.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.
z Rotate the jog dial to select "VMD MODE" on the status
bar.
[Screenshot 2]
The detection mode menu will be displayed.
z Rotate the jog dial to select "SENSITIVITY" on the status
bar.
[Screenshot 2]
The sensitivity of the selected detection area will be dis-
played.
x Set the detection mode.
Move the cursor to the desired detection mode using
the arrows button (AB).
Move the cursor on the desired detection mode using
the arrows button (A B) and check the radio button
next to the selected mode using the arrows button (C
D).
x Move the cross cursor to select an area using the
Refer to the following for further information about each
of the detection modes.
arrows button (A B).
c Select the sensitivity for the selected area from the fol-
lowing.
<ANY AREA>
An event action will be performed according to the set-
tings when "motion" is detected in any of the set motion
detection areas.
OFF: No motion will be detected in this area.
LOW: Low sensitivity
MID: Standard sensitivity
HIGH: High sensitivity
<VECTOR>
Move the cursor to an area for the settings of VECTOR
using the arrows button (B) and select an area using
the arrows button (C D). Move the cursor to the para-
meter box of the selected area using the arrows button
(B), and then press the arrows button (C D) to select
an interval time for an object moving between each
area from the following.
v To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.
→ The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m(min)
102
<DURATION>
Move the cursor to the parameter box of each area
Motion is detected in area C within 20 seconds after
being detected in area B.
using the arrows button (B) and select a moving dura-
tion for an object in each area from the following using
the arrows button (CD).
Motion is detected in area D within 10 seconds after
being detected in area C.
When all of the above have occurred, an event action
will be performed.
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m
c To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.
→ The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.
<DURATION (to detect objects that keep moving in the
area)>
An event action will be performed according to the set-
tings when an object keeps moving for the set period in
the detection area. For example, in case of the following
settings; 10 sec. for the areas A and B, 20 sec. for area
C and 30 sec. for area D:
8About the Detection mode
Perform the settings of the detection mode (method of
detection) in the set detection area. Specifying a method of
detection in a detection area is available by setting the
detection mode.
An event action will be performed when an object
keeps moving for 10 seconds in area A or B, or for 20
seconds in area C, or for 30 seconds in area D.
There are three detection modes as follows.
Important:
Activating two or more detection modes simultaneously
is not possible.
A
C
B
D
<ANY AREA (to detect "motion" in the area)>
An event action will be performed according to the set-
tings when "motion" is detected in any of the set motion
detection areas.
ꢀ [Alarm Setup] Perform the settings for the
A
C
B
D
alarm auto reset and alarm disarm
Perform the settings for the alarm display duration. The
alarm display will automatically disappear when the display
duration has passed. (Alarm Auto Reset)
Perform the settings to suspend the set duration when the
same type of event (motion detection, video loss, terminal
alarm, command alarm) has occurred sequentially so that
the event action will not be performed each time. (Alarm
Disarm)
Any motion will be detected anywhere in the A, B, C, D
areas.
<VECTOR (to detect object moving to a certain direc-
tion)>
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Event Setup
VMD Setup
Alarm Auto Reset
Alarm Disarm Time
OFF
2s
I
I
An event action will be performed according to the set-
tings when an object moves within the set time to the
other detection area in the set order.
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
10 s
A
C
B
D
8Alarm Auto Reset
The following are possible for the alarm auto reset.
When OFF is selected, the alarm display will not automati-
cally disappear.
10 s
To erase the alarm display, press the ALARM RESET but-
ton.
OFF/1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)
40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m4 m/5 m
The following is an example.
Motion is detected in area B within 10 seconds after
being detected in area A.
103
8Alarm Disarm Time
The following are possible for the alarm disarm.
2 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)
ꢀ [Terminal Setup] Perform the settings for
the alarm terminal polarity.
Select how to supply the signal to the alarm terminal.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Event Setup
VMD Setup
Terminal Setup
N.O.
I
Alarm Setup
Terminal Setup
N.O.: Signals will be supplied when short-circuited.
(Normally Open)
N.C.: Signals will be supplied when open-circuited.
(Normally Closed)
Note: It is possible to set polarities for each of the alarm
inputs 1-16 respectively using a PC via a network.
104
I [Schedule] Settings for the recording/event action schedule
Perform the settings for the recording schedules of record-
ing and event action by designating a day of the week and
time.
8Resolution
Select a resolution for images to be recorded from the fol-
lowing.
A day can be divided into up to 6 time zones, and record-
ing programs and event action programs can be assigned
to each time zone to create a recording schedule.
Up to 4 normal recording programs (REC Program) and up
to 4 event action programs (Event Program) can be creat-
ed. Perform the settings for the REC Program: resolution
and recording rate. Perform the settings for the Event
Program: action mode for each event type and auto copy.
It is possible to create special days apart from the normal
schedule, and a recording program of another day of the
week can be switched to a special day’s program automati-
cally.
FRAME 3D ON: High resolution (720 x 576) with the motion
blur compensation
FRAME 3D OFF: High resolution (720 x 576)
FIELD: Standard resolution (720 x 288)
SIF: Low resolution (360 x 288)
Note: When "FRAME 3D ON" is selected, it is possible to
record a moving object with less blurring.
Important:
• It is recommended to set same value for the resolution
of emergency recording as the resolution of manual
recording and schedule recording.
Flowchart on how to create a schedule
Follow the procedures below to create schedules.
• In the following cases, recording will not be performed
for around 4 seconds:
• When resolution is switched such as when a different
resolution is set depending on different time zones
• When the SETUP MENU is closed after changing the
settings
Create REC Program/Event Program.
(aPage 105 and 107)
8Recording Rate for Each Recording Mode
Create a timetable. (aPage 108)
Perform the settings of the recording rate for each record-
ing mode (manual recording, schedule recording and event
recording).
Assign REC Program/Event Program to a timetable.
Assign the maximum recording rates according to the reso-
lution for each recording mode.
(aPage 108)
The following are the maximum recording rate for each res-
olution.
ꢀ [REC Program] Create a recording program
Perform the settings of resolution, and recording rate for
each recording mode, and the recording rate and image
quality of each camera channel. Up to 4 recording pro-
grams can be created.
Resolution
FRAME 3D ON
FRAME 3D OFF
FIELD
Maximum recording rate
25 ips
25 ips
50 ips
100 ips
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
SIF
LIVE
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
Event Program 4
Time Table
I
I
I
I
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
The following are available for the recording rate for each
resolution.
OFF/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/
25 ips/50 ips/100 ips
Important:
• When "FRAME" is selected for "Resolution", "50 ips" and
"100 ips" are not available. When "FIELD" is selected,
"100 ips" is not available.
• The total of the recording rates for each recording
mode must be less than the maximum recording rate of
each resolution.
Examples: When "FIELD" is selected and set, the total
of the recording rates for each recording mode
must be less than 50 ips.
Recording Program 1
SET
Resolution
FIELD
I
I
Recording Table
Manual REC 15 ipsSchedule REC 15 ipsEvent REC 30 ips
M
Tim
REC
MANUAL
SCHEDULE
PRE EVENT
POST EVENT
TIME RATE QUALITY
RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY
TIME
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SFA
SFA
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
Eve
SFA
Spe
CAM4
SFA
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM9
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
CANCEL
O K
Manual recording: 12.5 ips
Schedule recording: 12.5 ips
Event recording: 25 ips
105
The total of the recording rates between recording rates of
pre-event recording and recording rates of post-event
recording for each camera channel must be less than the
recording rate as described in "Recording Rate for Each
Recording Mode" above.
8Recording Rate and Image Quality for Each
Camera Channel
Perform the settings for recording rate, image quality and
recording duration for each camera channel (only for pre-
event recording and post-event recording).
Perform the settings for each recording mode. Assign the
recording rate for each camera channel as described in
"Recording Rate for Each Recording Mode" above.
The following are for the recording rate. When OFF is
selected, images from the selected camera channel will not
be recorded.
OFF/0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/0.5 ips/1 ips/1.7 ips/
2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips
AUTO: The recording rate will be set automatically. (Not
possible for pre-event recording and post-event record-
ing)
The following are available for the image quality.
SFA/SFB: Top quality (SUPER FINE)
FQA/FQB: High quality (FINE)
NQA/NQB: Standard quality (NORMAL)
EXA/EXB: Low quality (EXTENDED)
**A is suitable for less dynamic images.
**B is suitable for more dynamic images.
The following are available for the recording duration (only
event pre-recording and event post-recording).
1 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)
20 s/30 s/1 - 10 m (in 1 minute intervals)
20 - 60 m (in 10 minutes intervals)
Note: When "AUTO" is selected for a camera channel, the
maximum recording rate of this camera channel will be
one of the following parameters but less than the value
resulting from the following formula.
MAN. (MANUAL): The recording duration will be as follows
depending on the event type.
• At a motion detection: For 8 seconds
• At a video loss occurrence: During a video loss occur-
rence
Parameters:
0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/0.5 ips/1 ips/2 ips/3 ips/
5 ips/6 ips/7.5 ips/10 ips/15 ips/30 ips/60 ips
Formula:
• At a terminal alarm occurrence: During the supply of a
signal
(Recording rate of each recording mode) – (Recording rate of
camera channels whose recording rate is numerically set (ips))
• At a command alarm: For 8 seconds
CON. (CONTINUE): Recording will be performed continu-
ously until the ALARM RESET button is pressed.
Number of camera channels whose recording rate is AUTO
However, when "FRAME 3D ON", "FRAME 3D OFF" or
"SIF" is selected, the maximum recording rate of this
camera channel will be up to 25 ips.
Notes:
• Available recording duration for pre-event recording will
differ depending on the settings of "Resolution" and
"Recording Rate and Quality" for pre-event recording as
below:
Important:
The total of the recording rates of camera channels in
the same recording mode must be less than the record-
ing rate as described in "Recording Rate for Each
Recording Mode" above.
Examples: When selecting "FIELD" for resolution,
"12.5 ips" for manual recording, "12.5 ips" for sched-
ule recording, "25 ips" for event recording:
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (manual record-
ing): less than 12.5 ips
Recording
rate
FRAME 3D ON FIELD
FRAME 3D OFF
SIF
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
1
5 m (min)
2 m (min)
1 m (min)
1 m (min)
1 m (min)
30 s
10 m (min)
20 m (min)
10 m (min)
6 m (min)
5 m (min)
4 m (min)
2 m (min)
1 m (min)
30 s
5 m (min)
3 m (min)
2 m (min)
2 m (min)
1 m (min)
30 s
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (schedule
recording): less than 12.5 ips
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (event record-
ing): less than 25 ips
1.7
2.5
4.2
5
10 s
10 s
20 s
7 s
10 s
20 s
When the total of the recording rates becomes more than
the set value, the recording mode section will turn red.
6 s
10 s
20 s
6.3
8.3
12.5
25
4 s
9 s
10 s
3 s
7 s
10 s
Recording Program 1
FIELD
SET
Resolution
Recording Table
I
I
2 s
4 s
9 s
Manual REC 15 ipsSchedule REC 15 ipsEvent REC 30 ips
M
Tim
REC
MANUAL
SCHEDULE
PRE EVENT
POST EVENT
RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY
TIME RATE QUALITY
TIME
1 s
2 s
4 s
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
SFA
SFA
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
1ips
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
5s
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
30s
Eve
SFA
Spe
CAM4
SFA
50
-
1 s
-
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM9
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
SFA
CANCEL
4
O K
106
• When a pre-recording area is created in an optional
extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series), it is possible to per-
form pre-event recording for up to 60 minutes accord-
ing to the resolution, recording rate and disk space for
pre-event recording. Refer to page 135 for descriptions
of how to create the pre-recording area. Pre-event
recording for the camera channel that has the pre-
recording area in the extension unit will always be per-
formed on the pre-recording area.
8VMD
Perform the settings of event action at a motion detection or
the settings of the auto copy function.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
Time Table
I
I
I
I
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
VMD
Operation Mode
Auto Copy
I
I
ALARM
OFF
OK
CANCEL
• When the set pre-event recording duration is impossi-
ble to apply, recording mode section of pre-event
recording will turn red.
• When the recording rate is low, images may be record-
ed for a longer duration than the set pre-event record-
ing duration.
• Pre-event recording will not be performed for a camera
channel whose post-event recording rate is OFF.
Perform the settings for the following operation mode. Refer
to page 45 for further information about each operation
mode.
ACT DET (Activity Detection Mode): Performs only
recording, writing an event log and camera movement
to a preset position at an event occurrence. Other event
actions will not be performed.
ALARM (Alarm Mode): Performs every event action
according to the settings.
Important:
Pre-event recording image only just recorded will be delet-
ed in the following cases:
• When the SETUP MENU is closed after changing the
settings
• When post-event recording is newly performed
• When the time zone of a schedule switched and record-
ing had just started
Auto copy is the function to copy recorded images auto-
matically onto the copy area of the hard disk or the DVD-
RAM disk.
• When the date has been changed
Select ON or OFF to enable or disable the auto copy func-
tion.
ON: Enable the auto copy function
OFF: Disable the auto copy function
ꢀ [Event Program] Create event programs for
an event occurrence
Perform the settings of event action for each event type
(motion detection, video loss, terminal/command alarm) or
of auto copy.
Important:
• When "OFF" is selected for "Auto Copy" of "Basic Setup"
on "System", the auto copy function will not work even
though "ON" is selected for this setting.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Select "HDD", "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" for "Auto Copy".
• Images recorded (by pre-event recording) in the pre-
recording area in the extension unit will not be copied
automatically.
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
Event Program 4
Time Table
I
I
I
I
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
8Video Loss
Perform the settings of an event action at a video loss or the
settings of the auto copy function.
The contents to be set are the same as the settings for
"VMD" above.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
I
I
I
Time Table
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
Event Program 1
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
SETUP
VMD
Video Loss
Terminal/Command Alarm
I
I
I
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
Time Table
I
I
I
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
O K
CANCEL
Video Loss
Operation Mode
Auto Copy
I
I
ALARM
OFF
OK
CANCEL
107
[Screenshot 2]
8Terminal/command alarm
The pop-up setting menu of the timetable for every day of
the week will be displayed.
The cursor will be displayed and will move to "MON"
(Monday).
Perform the settings of an event action at a terminal/com-
mand alarm occurrence or the settings of the auto copy
function.
The contents to be set are the same as the settings for
"VMD" above.
Maintenance
Recording
Event
12PM
SETUP MENU
12AM
12AM
6AM
6PM
REC
EVT
MON
Time Table
REC
EVT
TUE
WED
THU
FRI
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
REC
EVT
LIVE
REC
EVT
SETUP
SETUP
SETUP
Event Program 1
Event Program 2
Event Program 3
I
I
I
Time Table
REC
EVT
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
REC
EVT
SAT
SUN
DAILY
EXT
Terminal/CommandAlarm
REC
EVT
Operation Mode
Auto Copy
I
I
ALARM
OFF
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
OK
CANCEL
OK
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT
CANCEL
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4
x Select a day of the week using the arrows button (CD)
and press the SET button.
Note: When a signal is supplied from the ALARM/CON-
TROL connector on the rear panel the external
recording mode changeover terminal (pin no. 24) of
the unit will work with the set timetable for "EXT."
ꢀ [Time Table] Assignment of REC Program
and Event Program after setting the time
zone
Create recording timetables for each day of the week, and
assign REC Program and Event Program to each timetable.
Up to 6 recording programs can be created.
[Screenshot 3]
The pop-up settings menu of the timetable for the selected
day of the week will be displayed.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
12AM
12AM
6AM
12PM
6PM
Maintenance
Time Table (MON)
Copy the Other Time Table
New Time Table Setup
Recording
Event
Time Table
SETUP MENU
MON
TUE
WED
THU
FRI
LIVE
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
TUE
Time Table
Period 1
Period 2
Period 3
Period 4
Period 5
Period 6
12
08
12
01
05
09
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM
00 AM
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
08
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM
00 PM
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
12
01
05
09
12
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
00 AM
SAT
SUN
DAILY
EXT
O K
CANCEL
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4
REC
P1
P2
P3
P4
EVT
P1
P2
P3
P4
Do the following to create timetables.
c Select "New Time Table Setup" using the arrows button
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation after displaying the timetable window.
(CD) and rotate the jog dial to check the radio button.
[Screenshot 4]
The radio button for "New Time Table Setup" is checked.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
12AM
12AM
6AM
12PM
6PM
Time Table
MON
TUE
WED
THU
FRI
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
Recording
Copy the Other Time Table
Event
SETUP MENU Maintenance
LIVE
Time Table (MON)
TUE
New Time Table Setup
Time Table
Period 1
Period 2
Period 3
Period 4
Period 5
Period 6
12
08
12
01
05
09
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM
00 AM
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
08
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM
00 PM
REC Program
Event Progra
Special Day
12
01
05
09
12
SAT
00 PM
00 PM
00 PM
00 AM
SUN
DAILY
EXT
O K
CANCEL
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4
REC
P1
P2
P3
P4
EVT
P1
P2
P3
P4
z Press the SET button.
v Move the cursor to the start time input box for "Period 1"
using the arrows button.
b Rotate the jog dial to set the start time.
The end time can be set in the same way.
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to set for "Period 2" - "Period 6".
(It is not necessary to set for all of "Period 1" - "Period
6".)
108
n Select OK using the arrows button and press the SET
ꢀ [Special Days] Perform the settings for
button.
recording programs for special days
Assign timetables to special days aside from other days of
the week. Timetables for special days can be set for up to
30 days.
Perform the settings to specify dates as special days and
apply the recording schedule to the special days.
Notes:
• The start time and end time can be set in 15 min-
utes intervals.
• To copy a timetable that is set for a different day of
the week, select "Copy the Other Time Table" and
select a day of the week by rotating the jog dial in
step 3.
Then, move the cursor to the "day of the week" box,
press the arrows button (B) and select a day of the
week by rotating the jog dial. After selecting, move
the cursor to OK and press the SET button.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Time Table
DATE
MODE
SUN 16 --
DATE
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
MODE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
1
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
REC Program
Event Program
Special Days
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
[Screenshot 5]
The settings are applied to the selected timetable and the
timetable for all the days of the week will be displayed.
Maintenance
Recording
Event
12PM
SETUP MENU
12AM
12AM
6AM
6PM
REC
EVT
MON
Time Table
REC
EVT
TUE
WED
THU
FRI
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
SAT
SUN
DAILY
EXT
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
REC
EVT
OK
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT
CANCEL
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4
m Move the cursor to the time zone of the day of the week
to which the REC program is to be assigned using the
arrows button.
, Rotate the jog dial to select a desired REC program/
Event program.
(Rotating the jog dial changes the displayed REC pro-
gram.)
REC program will be displayed with different colours.
Yellow: REC program 1/Event program 1
Green: REC program 2/Event program 2
Pale purple: REC program 3/Event program 3
Indigo blue: REC program 4/Event program 4
It is possible to display the assigned REC Program/
Event Program window (pages 105 and 107) by press-
ing the SET button.
Repeat steps 7 and 8 to assign REC program to other
timetables.
. Move the cursor to OK using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
→ The REC program/Event program will be assigned
to the selected time zone and the selected
timetable window will be closed.
Note: When the SET button is pressed after moving the
cursor to CANCEL in step 9, the settings will be
canceled and the selected timetable window will be
closed.
109
I [Switcher] Settings for the switcher function
Perform the settings for image switching such as the
sequential display setting or the waiting screen (while log-
ging out) setting for displaying on monitors 1 and 2.
[Screenshot 2]
The "Live Sequence" pop-up menu will be displayed.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DWELL
LIVE
1
2
3
4
2s
1
--
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
9
9
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
2
--
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
2s
2s
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
Live Sequence
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP
3
--
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
INT
4
5
6
7
8
--
--
--
--
--
2s
OFF
CAM1
5
6
7
8
2s
2s
2s
2s
Login Screen
Secret View
OFF
OK
CANCEL
x Move the cursor to "CAM" of "STEP 1" using the arrows
button.
ꢀ [Monitor 1] Switcher function of monitor 1
Perform the settings for the switcher function of monitor 1.
[Screenshot 3]
The cursor moves to "CAM".
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
Live Sequence
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
INT
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DWELL
OFF
CAM1
1
2
3
4
2s
1
--
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
9
9
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
Login Screen
Secret View
2
--
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
2s
OFF
2s
3
--
4
5
6
7
8
--
--
--
--
--
2s
5
6
7
8
2s
2s
2s
2s
OK
CANCEL
8Live Sequence
c Select how to display images from camera channels in
"STEP 1" from the following by rotating the jog dial.
1, 2, ... , 16: Displays an image from the selected cam-
era channel on a single screen.
Perform the settings for the sequential display of live
images as follows.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "Monitor1" menu of "Switcher" on
the SETUP MENU.
1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels
1 - 4 on a 4-split screen.
5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels
5 - 8 on a 4-split screen.
9-9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split
screen.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
Live Sequence
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
INT
OFF
CAM1
Login Screen
Secret View
OFF
9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from
camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.
13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from
camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.
1 - 9: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 9 on a
9-split screen.
10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from
camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split screen.
--: Skips the selected step.
z Move the cursor to "Live Sequence" using the arrows
button (CD) and press the SET button.
v When displaying images from camera channels "1 - 16"
on a single screen is selected in step 3, select the cam-
era position.
Move the cursor to "PRESET" in "STEP 1" using the
arrows button.
110
[Screenshot 4]
The cursor moves to the "PRESET" in "STEP 1".
8Auto Skip
Select ON of OFF to determine whether or not to skip the
camera channel without supplying the video input signal
because it is not connected, etc.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
ON: Skips a channel if it is not connected.
OFF: Displays a black screen for a channel not connected.
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DW
E
LL
1
1
1
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
9
1-8
9-16
11
-- 2s
2s
2
2
1
10
11
12
13
14
15
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
3
3
64
2s
2s
4
4
5
--
--
--
--
12
5
6
7
8
1-4
1-4
5-8
9-12
2s
2s
2s
2s
5-8
9-12
13-16
8Login Screen
16 13-16
OK
CANCEL
Select a camera image to be displayed during the login
procedure from the following.
CAM1 - 16: Displays an image from the selected camera
channel.
QUAD1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 4
on a 4-split screen.
QUAD5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels 5 - 8
on a 4-split screen.
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split
screen.
b Rotate the jog dial to select a preset position number
for which image is displayed in "STEP 1" from the follow-
ing.
1 - 64: Moves to the selected preset number.
--: Does not move to the preset position.
n Select "DWELL" in "STEP 1" using the arrows button.
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.
7SCREEN: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 7 on
a 7-split screen.
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a
9-split screen.
[Screenshot 5]
The cursor moves to"DWELL" in "STEP 1".
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DW
E
LL
1
1
1
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
2s
9
1-8
9-16
11
-- 2s
2
2s
2
1
10
11
12
13
14
15
--
--
--
--
--
--
--
3
3
64
2s
2s
4
4
5
--
--
--
--
12
5
6
7
8
1-4
1-4
5-8
9-12
2s
2s
2s
2s
5-8
9-12
13-16
16 13-16
OK
CANCEL
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split
screen.
10SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 10 on a 10-split screen.
13SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 13 on a 13-split screen.
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.
--: No camera image will be displayed (black screen)
m Rotate the jog dial to select an interval time to go to the
next sequential step from 1 - 30 seconds (in 1 second
intervals).
The sequence step is skipped when "0 s" is selected.
Repeat steps 2 and 7 to set for the other sequence
steps.
, Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
→ The settings for the sequential display are set and
the sequence setting menu closes.
8Secret View
The secret view is a function to display a black screen on
monitor 1 when camera images are displayed with a single
screen on monitor 2. Select ON or OFF to determine
whether to enable or disable the secret view function.
ON: Enables the secret view function. (Camera images dis-
played with a single screen on monitor 2 will be dis-
played while monitor 1 has a black screen.)
Note: If you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 8 and
press the SET button, the setting will be canceled
and the sequence setting menu will be closed.
8Sequence Timing
OFF: Disables the secret view function.
Select an image switching method from the following.
INT: Switches images according to the settings for the live
sequence.
EXT: Switches images by signals from an external device.
MON 2: Match with the image switching timing of the live
sequence on monitor 2.
111
ꢀ [Monitor 2] Switcher function of monitor 2
Perform the settings for the switcher function of monitor 2.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
Live Sequence
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
I
I
I
I
SETUP
INT
OFF
CAM1
Login Screen
8Live Sequence
The settings for "Live Sequence" are the same as for
"Monitor1". Refer to page 110 for further information.
8Sequence Timing
The settings for "Sequence Timing" are the same as for
"Monitor1". Refer to page 111 for further information.
Notes:
• Select "EXT" when an external device that can transmit
a sequence signal is connected.
• The sequence changeover I/O (pin no.21) of the
ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel will
supply signals when "INT" is selected and will receive
signals when "EXT" is selected.
8Auto Skip
The settings for "Auto Skip" are the same as for "Monitor1".
Refer to page 111 for further information.
8Login Screen
The settings for "Login Screen" are the same as for
"Monitor1". Refer to page 111 for further information.
112
I [Display]
Perform the display settings for monitors 1 and 2 connected
to the unit.
[Screenshot 2]
The camera title pop-up window will be displayed.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
LIVE
Camera Title
SETUP
L-UPPER
R-LOWER
WHITE
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup
OSD Setup
Time & Date Display Position
Camera Title Display Position
Line Color on the Multi Screen
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
OK
CANCEL
x Move the cursor to "CAM1" using the arrows button.
ꢀ OSD Setup
[Screenshot 3]
The cursor moves to " CAM1".
Perform the On Screen Display settings for monitor 1 and
monitor 2 such as the settings of camera titles or the set-
tings of the time display position.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
CAM1
OSD Setu
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
CAM1
SETUP MENU
CAM2
LIVE
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
CAM2
CAM3
CAM3
Camera Title
SETUP
L-UPPER
R-LOWER
WHITE
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
Time & Date Display Position
Camera Title Display Position
Line Color on the Multi Screen
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
OK
CANCEL
c Select a character to be entered by rotating the jog dial.
Up to 16 characters can be entered.
8Camera Title
Perform the settings for the camera title. It is possible to
display a camera title on the monitor 1/monitor 2, and
record it as a part of the recorded image (page 98). Do the
following to set the camera title.
v Move the cursor to the right side of the entered charac-
ter using the arrows button.
Repeat steps 3 and 4 to enter the camera title.
Notes:
[Screenshot 1]
• To correct the entered characters, move the cursor
to the character to be corrected and press the
STOP button to delete it. Enter a correct character
after deleting.
• To copy the camera title that has been set for
another camera channel, follow the procedure
below.
Start operation from the "OSD Setup" menu.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Camera Title
SETUP
L-UPPER
R-LOWER
WHITE
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup
Time & Date Display Position
Camera Title Display Position
Line Color on the Multi Screen
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
1. Move the cursor to "CAM 1" in step 2 on the pre-
vious page and press the SET button. The fol-
lowing screen will be displayed.
SETU
CAM2
Copy Another Camera Title
I
LIVE
z Move the cursor to "Camera Title" using the arrows but-
P
Comm
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
ton (C D) and press the SET button.
Monito
Monito
O K
CANCEL
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
OK
CANCEL
2. Select the camera channel for which the cam-
era title is to be copied by rotating the jog dial.
113
3. Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button
and press the SET button. The camera title will
be copied.
Notes:
• When setting the time and date to be recorded together
with images, the time display will be recorded in the
selected position.
• Refer to page 98 for further information about
"Embedded REC (Time & Date)".
• The following characters can be entered for a cam-
era title:
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P
Q R S T U V W X Y Z a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r
s t u v w x y z À Ä Â Æ Ç É Ì Ñ Ò Ö Ù Ü Ø ß à á â ä
å æ ç è é ê ë ì í î ï ñ ò ó ô ö ù ú ü ø < > = ? ” # & ( )
* + , - . / : ; SP
8Camera Title Display Position
Select a camera title display position from the following.
L-UPPER: Displays the camera title at the upper left of the
screen.
[Screenshot 4]
The camera title is entered.
L-LOWER: Displays the camera title at the lower left of the
screen.
R-UPPER: Displays the camera title at the upper right of
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
the screen.
LIVE
R-LOWER: Displays the camera title at the lower right of
OSD Setup
CAM1CAM1
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
CAM2
ENTRANCE
the screen.
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
CENTRE: Displays the camera title at the centre of the
screen.
OK
CANCEL
Note: When setting the camera title to be recorded togeth-
er with images, the time display will be embedded in
the selected position.
Refer to page 98 for further information about
"Embedded REC (title)".
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
OSD Setup
LIVE
CAM9CAM9
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
CAM10
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
8Line Colour on the Multi Screen
Select a line colour from the following.
WHITE: Displays white lines.
GREY: Displays grey lines.
OK
CANCEL
BLACK: Displays black lines.
b Press the arrows button to move the cursor to "OK" and
press the SET button.
ꢀ [Monitor 1] Settings on monitor 1 display
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the time, cam-
era title and alarm display on monitor 1.
→ The camera title will be set and the setting window
of the camera title will be closed.
Notes:
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
• If you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 5 and
press the SET button, the setting will be canceled
and the setting window of the camera title will be
closed.
LIVE
ON
ON
ON
Time & Date Display
Camera Title Display
Alarm Display
OSD Setup
I
I
I
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
• It is possible to set "Camera Title [Display]" to dis-
play a camera title on monitor 2 and "Camera Title
[Embedded]" to embed/display a camera title on
monitor 1 individually using a PC via a network.
Refer to the Network Setup Instruction (PDF) for fur-
ther information.
8Time & Date Display
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the time.
ON: Displays time.
8Time & Date Display Position
OFF: Does not function.
Select a time and date display position from the following.
L-UPPER: Displays the time at the upper left of the screen.
R-UPPER: Displays the time at the upper right of the
screen.
L-LOWER: Displays the time at the lower left of the screen.
R-LOWER: Displays the time at the lower right of the
screen.
114
8Camera Title Display
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the camera
title.
ON: Displays the camera title.
OFF: Does not function.
8Alarm Display
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate the alarm dis-
play at an event occurrence.
ON: Displays the alarm display at an event occurrence.
OFF: Does not function.
ꢀ [Monitor2] Settings on monitor 2 display
Perform the display settings for monitor 2 such as the dis-
play mode (task bar style), time display position on/off,
camera title display position, etc.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Display Mode
T&D and Status Display Position
Camera Title Display
MODE
LOWER
ON
1
I
I
I
OSD Setup
Monitor
Monitor
1
2
The following explain the settings for monitor 2 and the VGA
monitor such as the display mode (task bar style), time dis-
play position, camera title display ON/OFF, etc.
8Display Mode
Select a display mode (task bar style) from the following.
Refer to page 11 for further information about the task bar.
MODE 1: Select [MODE 1] for the display mode.
MODE 2: Select [MODE 2] for the display mode.
MODE 3: Select [MODE 3] for the display mode.
8T & D and Status Display Position
When selecting MODE 1, select the position of the time and
date display and the status from the following.
UPPER: Displays them in the upper part of the screen.
LOWER: Displays them in the lower part of the screen.
8Camera Title Display
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the camera
title.
ON: Displays the camera title.
OFF: Does not function.
115
I [Comm] Settings for communication with other devices
It is necessary to adjust the communication speed and use
the same communication protocol with external devices
such as a controller when connecting those external
devices to the DATA port or the SERIAL connector
(RS232C).
• To prevent operation mistakes, set the unused camera
channels to off.
It is possible to compensate for the video signal trans-
mission loss from the camera when using the VIDEO IN
connector 1 - 8. (cable compensation)
It is also necessary to perform the settings for the network
such as the IP address and the gateway address when
operating this unit a PC via a network such as a LAN.
These are the descriptions of how to perform the required
settings for communication with external devices.
Perform the settings for the cable compensation
according to the length of cable used.
S: When the length of cable used is shorter than 500 m
M: When the length of cable used is longer than 500 m
and shorter than 900 m
L: When the length of cable used is longer than 900 m
and shorter than 1 200 m
ꢀ [Camera Control] Settings for the communi-
cation method and the cable compensation
for camera control
Select a communication method for each camera channel
to control cameras from the following.
Notes:
• Use 5C-2V cables for the cable compensation.
• Perform the settings for the cable compensation prop-
erly according to the cable length. Otherwise camera
pictures may not be displayed/recorded correctly.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Camera Control
PS.Data Setup
RS485 Setup
Type of Camera Control
I
ꢀ [PS.Data Setup] Settings for the PS·Data
Perform the following settings for the PS·Data.
CAM
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
COMP
TYPE
COAX
COAX
COAX
COAX
COAX
COAX
COAX
COAX
CAM
TYPE
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
CAM9
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
RS232C Setup
PSD
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
NTP Setup
RS485
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
001
001
OFF
9600
8
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
Unit Address(System)
Unit Address(Controller)
Cascade
Baud Rate
Data Bit
Parity
Stop Bit
Retry Timing
Alarm Data
Camera Number Setup
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
RS232C Setup
NONE
1
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
OFF
1s
NTP Setup
COAX: Controls camera with the coaxial communication
(CAM 1 - 8 CH are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 1 -
6 CH are available for the WJ-HD309)
SETUP
PSD: Controls camera with the PS·Data. (CAM 9 - 16 CH
are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 7 - 9 CH are
available for the WJ-HD309)
8Unit Address (System)
RS485: Controls camera with the RS485 communication.
(CAM 1 - 16 CH are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 1
- 9 CH are available for the WJ-HD309)
OFF: Does not control camera (CAM 1 - 16 CH are avail-
able)
A unit address (System) is a unique number assigning to
PS·Data devices. The addresses must be unique to identify
system devices when connecting multiple devices compati-
ble with PS·Data. Numbers, "001"-"099", are to be assigned
as the unit addresses to the system devices.
Notes:
8Unit Address (Controller)
• Perform settings according to the cameras connected
to this unit.
• CAM 9-16 control 4 cameras each (only for the WJ-
HD316).
The unit address (controller) is used to control a PS·Data
device connected to this unit. Numbers, "001" - "099" are to
be assigned.
• When using the coaxial communication to control cam-
eras, connect cameras to the VIDEO IN connectors 1 -
8 for the WJ-HD316 (1 - 6 for the WJ-HD309) (coaxial
communication compatible). When controlling cameras
connected to other VIDEO IN connectors with coaxial
communication, use a coaxial communication unit (WJ-
MP204). In this case, select "PSD" for the communica-
tion method for the camera channels to be controlled
through the coaxial communication unit.
8Cascade
Select ON or OFF whether or not to use the cascade con-
nection.
Set this to ON when connecting two or more units or in the
cascade connection.
ON: Select this when connecting units in the cascade con-
nection.
OFF: Does not function.
116
[Screenshot 2]
8Baud Rate
The "Camera Number Setup" pop-up window will be dis-
played.
Select the communication speed for data transmission with
a connected device from the following.
2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200/38 400 bps
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Camera Number Setup
CI
Camera
8Data Bit
CAM PORT
CAM NO.
001
CAM PORT CAM NO.
PS.DATA
RS485 Se
1
9
009
010
2
002
003
004
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
RS232C S
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
8 bit
3
011
NW Setup
NW Setup
4
012
013
5
005
NTP Setu
6
006
014
015
016
7
007
008
8
8Parity
O K
CANCEL
Select a method to check a transmission error at communi-
cation from the following.
NONE: No parity check
EVEN: Even parity
ODD: Odd parity
x Move the cursor to a desired "CAM No." of "CAM PORT"
using the arrows button.
[Screenshot 3]
The cursor will move to the selected "CAM No." of "CAM
PORT".
8Stop Bit
Select a stop bit from the following.
1 bit/2 bit
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
8Retry Timing
Camera Number Setup
CI
Camera
CAM PORT
CAM NO.
001
CAM PORT CAM NO.
PS.DATA
RS485 Se
RS232C S
1
9
009
010
Select a retransmission interval for when data reception is
not confirmed from the following.
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1 000 ms
2
002
003
004
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
3
011
NW Setup
NW Setup
4
012
013
5
005
NTP Setu
6
006
014
015
016
7
007
008
8
O K
CANCEL
8Alarm Data
Select a method to inform the connected controller of an
event occurrence from the following.
OFF: Does not function.
0 s: Informs the controller every time an event is detected.
1 s/5 s: Informs the controller when a specified time has
passed after detecting an event.
c Select a camera number by rotating the jog dial.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to assign camera numbers to the
other CAM PORT.
v Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
8Camera Number Setup
→ Camera numbers will be assigned and the "Camera
Number Setup" menu will be closed.
It is possible to assign a number to each camera channel to
operate cameras using the controller compatible with
PS·Data.
Note: When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4
and press the SET button, the settings will be can-
celed and the "Camera Number Setup" menu will be
closed.
Do the following to assign numbers to the camera chan-
nels.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "PS·Data Setup" menu.
ꢀ [RS485 Setup] Settings for RS485
Perform the following settings for RS485.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
001
001
OFF
9600
8
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
Unit Address(System)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Unit Address(Controller)
Cascade
Baud Rate
RS232C Setup
Data Bit
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU Maintenance
Switcher
NONE
1
LIVE
Parity
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
Stop Bit
OFF
1s
Retry Timing
Alarm Data
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
19200
Baud Rate
Control Camera CH
Data Bit
Parity
Stop Bit
I
I
I
I
I
NTP Setup
SETUP
SETUP
Camera Number Setup
8
NONE
1
RS232C Setup
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
NTP Setup
z Move the cursor to "Camera Number Setup" using the
arrows button (C D) and press the SET button.
117
v Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
8Baud Rate
Select the communication speed for data transmission with
a connected device from the following.
4 800/9 600/19 200 bps
→ Camera channels and ports to be controlled will be
assigned and the "Control Camera CH" menu will be
closed.
8Control Camera CH
Notes:
It is possible to assign camera channels to the RS485 ports
1 and 2 as shown below.
• When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4
and press the SET button, the settings will be can-
celed and the "Camera Number Setup" menu will be
closed.
• The unit number of the camera will be congruent
with the camera number.
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "RS485 Setup" menu.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
19200
Baud Rate
Control Camera CH
Data Bit
Parity
Stop Bit
I
I
I
I
I
8Data Bit
SETUP
8
NONE
1
The data length for communication will be displayed.
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
RS232C Setup
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
NTP Setup
8Parity
Methods to check a transmission error at communication
will be displayed.
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
z Move the cursor to "Control Camera CH" using the
arrows button (CD) and press the SET button.
8Stop Bit
[Screenshot 2]
The "Control Camera CH" pop-up window will be displayed.
Number of stop bit will be displayed.
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Control Camera CH
ꢀ [RS232C Setup] Settings for RS232C
Perform the following settings for RS232C.
CI
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
Camera
PS.DATA
RS485 S
CAMERA
TERM
PORT1
PORT1
CAMERA
CAM9
TERM
CAM1
CAM2
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
RS232C
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
PORT1
NW Setu
NW Setu
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
NTP Setu
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
Unit Address(System)
Baud Rate
Data Bit
Parity
Stop Bit
I
I
I
I
I
I
O K
CANCEL
001
9600
8
NONE
1
RS232C Setup
OFF
Retry Timing
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
NTP Setup
x Move the cursor to a desired cell in the "TERM" column
using the arrows button.
[Screenshot 3]
The cursor will move to the selected cell in the "TERM" col-
umn.
8Unit Address(System)
A unit address (System) is a unique number assigned to
each system device. The addresses must be unique to
identify system devices when connecting multiple system
devices.
Numbers, "001"-"099", are to be assigned as the unit
addresses for the system devices.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Control Camera CH
CI
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
PORT2
Camera
PS.DATA
RS485 S
CAMERA
TERM
PORT1
PORT1
CAMERA
CAM9
TERM
CAM1
CAM2
CAM10
CAM11
CAM12
CAM13
CAM14
CAM15
CAM16
RS232C
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
PORT1
NW Setu
NW Setu
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
PORT1
NTP Setu
8Baud Rate
O K
CANCEL
Select the communication speed for data transmission with
a connected device from the following.
9 600/19 200/38 400 bps
c Select a port by rotating the jog dial.
PORT 1: Control through the RS485 port 1.
PORT 2: Control through the RS485 port 2.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to assign other camera channels
to be controlled through the RS485 ports.
118
8Data Bit
8Host Authentication
Select a data length for communication from the following.
7/8 bit
Select ON or OFF whether or not to restrict access by IP
addresses at the time of access from a PC to this unit.
When ON is selected, only PCs with registered IP address
can access this unit
8Parity
ON: Activates host authentication.
OFF: Does not function.
Select a method to check a transmission error at communi-
cation from the following.
NONE: No parity check
EVEN: Even parity
ODD: Odd parity
Note: When ON is selected for both the user authentication
and the host authentication, it is possible to operate the
unit only from a registered host. Operable functions will
differ depending on the user level setting of the authen-
ticated user. It is impossible to operate the unit from an
unregistered host.
8Stop Bit
Select a stop bit from the following.
1/2 bit
8Line Speed
8Retry Timing
The line speed will be displayed.
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
Select a retransmission interval for when data reception is
not confirmed from the following.
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1 000 ms
8Live Video Quality
Image quality level for a live (FQB: high quality) will be dis-
played.
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.
ꢀ [NW Setup 1] Basic network settings
Perform the following basic network settings to operate this
unit using a PC via a network such as a LAN.
ꢀ [NW Setup 2] Network connection settings
Perform the following network connection settings to oper-
ate this unit using a PC via a network such as a LAN.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
HTTP Port Number
User Authentication
Host Authentication
Line Speed
00080
OFF
OFF
AUTO
FQB
Camera Control
PS.Data Setup
RS485 Setup
I
I
I
I
I
RS232C Setup
Live Video Quality
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
NTP Setup
LIVE
Camera Control
PS.Data Setup
RS485 Setup
DHCP
OFF
I
I
I
I
I
192
255
192
168
255
168
000
250
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway
DNS
Primary
Secondary
DDNS
User Name
User Password
Access Interval
Host Name
HD316
255
000
000
001
RS232C Setup
MANUAL
000
000
000
000
000
000
.
.
.
.
.
.
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
000
000
OFF
I
NTP Setup
10m
I
I
8HTTP Port Number
Domain Name
localdomain
Specify the HTTP port number to be used to transfer
images from this unit. It is not necessary to change it for
normal use.
8DHCP
Select ON or OFF whether or not to use the DHCP server.
When obtaining IP addresses, net mask and a gateway
address from the DHCP server, set to ON.
If not, set to OFF and enter those addresses manually.
ON: Uses the DHCP server.
8User Authentication
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate user authenti-
cation at the time of access from a PC to this unit.
When ON is selected, the user authentication (login) win-
dow will be displayed at the time of access from a PC.
The top page will be displayed if the entered user name
and password are registered.
OFF: Does not use the DHCP server.
8IP Address
ON: Activates user authentication.
OFF: Does not function.
Enter an IP address when OFF is selected for "DHCP".
For this unit, enter 4 units of the decimal number (0-254).
Note: It is recommended to select ON for the user authenti-
8Subnet Mask
cation for security.
Enter a subnet mask according to the network configuration
when OFF is selected for "DHCP".
8Gateway
Enter the gateway address according to the network con-
figuration when OFF is selected for "DHCP".
119
8DNS
8Time Zone
Select "MANUAL" or "AUTO" to enable searching for an IP
address by its host name using DNS. When "OFF" is select-
ed for "DHCP" (no use of the DHCP server), select "MANU-
AL" and enter the domain name and the DNS server
address. If "ON" is selected for "DHCP" (use of the DHCP
server), select "AUTO". When DNS is not used, select "OFF".
When "MANUAL" is selected for DNS, enter the DNS server
address for "Primary" and "Secondary".
Set the time zone in accordance with the place of use when
using the NTP server for time adjustment.
8NTP Server Address
Enter the NTP server address when using the NTP server
for time adjustment.
8Refresh Interval
Select an interval of time inquiry to be transmitted to the
NTP server from the following.
1 h/2 h/6 h/12 h/24 h
8DDNS
Select ON and OFF whether or not to use the DDNS
(Dynamic Domain Name Server).
Selecting ON is available only when "MANUAL" or "AUTO" is
selected for "DNS".
Important:
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds
When "ON" is selected, perform the following.
User Name: Enter the user name registered in "DDNS".
Password: Enter the password for the user entered in
"User Name".
when changing the present time (accurate to within
seconds) using "Time Adjustment".
5
Access Interval: Select an interval to update DNS from the
following.
10 m/30 m/1 h/6 h/24 h
8Host Name
Enter the host address registered in DDNS.
Enter a host name of no more than 255 alphanumeric char-
acters. Hyphens (-) are also available for the host name.
8Domain Name
Enter the domain name of this unit.
Enter a domain name of no more than 255 alphanumeric
characters. Hyphens (-) are also available for the domain
name.
ꢀ [NTP Setup] Time adjustment of network
Perform the following settings for time adjustment.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
OFF
Camera Control
PS.DATA Setup
RS485 Setup
Time Adjustment
Time Zone
NTP Server Address
I
I
I
GMTT10:000
RS232C Setup
6h
Refresh Interval
I
NW Setup
NW Setup
1
2
NTP Setup
8Time Adjustment
Select ON and OFF whether or not to adjust the time with
reference to the NTP server.
ON: Adjusts time with reference to the NTP server.
OFF: Does not function.
Note: Time adjustment will be performed automatically
when the clock time is inaccurate to within 5 seconds
from the standard time of the NTP server.
120
I [System] Settings on System
Perform the following system settings required to operate
this unit.
OFF: Does not activate the auto logout function.
1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m/30 m: Activates the auto logout func-
tion when the selected time has passed after login.
Important:
ꢀ [Basic Setup] Basic system settings
• The auto logout function will not be activated when ON
is selected for "Auto Login".
Perform the following settings for basic operation.
• Depending on the user level of the auto login user,
operable functions may be different.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Basic Setup
ADMIN Password
*****
PSD User
ADMIN
Auto Login
Auto Login User
I
I
I
Time
&
Date
User Regist.
User Edit
ON
8Priority
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
ADMIN
Auto Logout
Priority
"GO TO LAST" before
Language
Beep(Operation)
Buzzer(Error)
Shutdown Time
Auto Copy
OFF
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Assign operating priorities when multiple users access this
unit simultaneously from the following.
Follow the priority: Operation by a user with a higher pri-
ority will be performed. When the priorities of the first
and the last accessed user are the same, post-priority
will be applied.
Follow the priority.
5s
ENGLISH
ON
2s
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
10s
OFF
8ADMIN Password
Pre-priority: Operation by the first accessed user will be
performed regardless of priority.
Post-priority: Operation by the last accessed user will be
performed regardless of priority.
Set the password for an administrator.
Enter 4-8 alphanumeric characters.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to
page 55 about the characters available.
8"GO TO LAST" before
Select time to be skipped to when the "GO TO LAST" button
is pressed during playback from the following.
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m
Important:
To enhance the security, change the password for an
administrator periodically.
8Language
8PSD User
Select a language for the SETUP MENU from the following.
JAPANESE/ENGLISH/FRANÇAIS/ESPAÑOL/DEUTSCH/
ITALIANO
When a user operates a controller compatible with PS·Data,
operation will be restricted by the priority and operational
level of the PSD user.
A PSD user should be one of the users registered in this
unit.
Important:
Displaying the language of the browser used to access
the unit from a PC will not be changed even though this
setting is changed.
8Auto Login
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate the auto login
function.
ON: Activates the auto login function.
OFF: Does not activate the auto login function. It is neces-
sary to perform the login operation every time this unit is
started up.
8Beep (Operation)
Select ON or OFF whether or not to sound the buzzer when
operating the buttons.
ON: Sounds the buzzer when operating the buttons.
OFF: Does not sound the buzzer when operating the but-
tons.
8Auto Login User
When ON is selected for "Auto Login", the user registered
as an auto login user in this setting can log into the unit
automatically.
An auto login user should be one of the users registered in
this unit.
8Buzzer (Error)
Select a buzzer operation when a problem has occurred
from the following.
OFF: Does not sound buzzer when a problem has
occurred.
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)/40 s/50 s/1 m/1 m/3 m/
4 m/5 m (in 1 minute intervals): A buzzer will sound
for the selected duration after a problem has occurred.
EXT: The buzzer will sound continuously until the "ALARM
RESET" button on the front panel of the unit is pressed.
8Auto Logout
Select ON or OFF whether or not to activate the auto logout
function.
When ON is selected, auto logout will be carried out after a
specified time has passed while displaying live images
without operation.
121
8Shutdown Time
8Time Setup
Select a waiting time before starting the internal processing
against the power outage after an outage detection signal
has been supplied to the unit from the following.
10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m
Adjust the current time and date.
Enter year, month, day, hour, minute and second in order,
move the cursor to "SET" and press the SET button.
Important:
8Auto Copy
Recording will stop for around 4 seconds just after set-
ting the date and time.
ON or OFF whether or not to copy recorded images to the
copy area on the hard disk automatically.
OFF: Does not copy automatically.
8Auto Adjust Time
ON: Copies recorded images to the copy area on the hard
disk of this unit.
Select a method for auto time adjustment from the follow-
ing.
When "MASTER" is selected, a signal will be supplied from
the ALARM/CONTROL connector as the MASTER time (see
below) at the specified time.
Important:
• When OFF is selected, the auto copy function at an
event occurrence and emergency recording will not
function.
• The auto copy will not work if a DVD-RAM disk drive is
not connected even though "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" is
selected.
OFF: Does not function.
MASTER: A signal will be supplied from the ALARM/CON-
TROL connector on the rear and the clock of the other
devices will be adjusted with reference to the time of
this unit.
• Images recorded (by pre-event recording) in the pre-
recording area in the extension unit will not be copied
automatically.
SLAVE: A signal will be supplied to the ALARM/CONTROL
connector on the rear and the clock of this unit will be
adjusted.
• When emergency recording/event recordings are per-
formed frequently, it may be possible that the auto copy
function does not function.
Important:
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds
• Images to be copied automatically will be 30 minute’s
worth of images recorded from the start of emergency
recording/event recording.
when changing the present time (accurate to within
seconds) using the time adjustment input (pin no.20) of
the ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel.
5
8Master Time
ꢀ [Time & Date] Setting of the date and time
Perform the following settings of the time and date.
Specify the time when supplying a signal from the
ALARM/CONTROL connector.
8Summer Time (Day Light Saving)
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Select the method of switching to summer time from the fol-
lowing.
Basic Setup
Date Format
Time Format
Time & Date
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY
12H
Time
&
Date
User Regist.
User Edit
.
.
:
1
JAN
03
12 00 00
AM
SET
OFF
12 :00 AM
AUTO
OFF: Does not function.
ON: Applies summer time.
AUTO: Applies summer time in accordance with the setting
of summer time (see next page).
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
I
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
I
I
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table
SETUP
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
8Summer Time (Day Light Saving) Table
8Date Format
Do the following to specify the start time and date and the
end time and date of summer time.
Select a display format for the date from the following. (Ex.
April 1, 2003)
YY.MM.DD: 03.4.1
MMM.DD.YY: APR.1.03
DD.MMM.YY: 1.APR.03
[Screenshot 1]
Start operation from the "Time & Date" menu.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
8Time Format
Basic Setup
Date Format
Time Format
Time & Date
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY
12H
Time
&
Date
Select a display format for the time from the following. (Ex.
3 o’ clock in the afternoon)
12h: 3:00:00 PM
User Regist.
User Edit
.
.
:
1
JAN
03
12 00 00
AM
SET
OFF
12 :00 AM
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
I
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
AUTO
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table
I
I
SETUP
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
24h: 15:00:00
122
z Move the cursor to "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)
Table" using the arrows button (C D) and press the
SET button.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Basic Setup
LIVE
User Name
I
I
Time
&
Date
User Password
User Regist.
User Edit
LV1
1
CAM1
Level
Priority
Default Screen
Camera Partitioning
I
I
I
I
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
[Screenshot 2]
The "Summer Time (Day Light Saving) Table" will be dis-
played.
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
View/Operate
CAM9
View/Operate
View/Operate CAM10 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM11 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM12 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM13 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM14 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM15 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM16 View/Operate
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
SET
Y
1
ON
SETUP MEN
24
--
--
--
24
--
D
D
JUN
--
M
M
M
M
M
M
03
--
--
01
--
--
H
00
M
LIVE
OFF
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
--
--
--
M
M
M
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
D
D
--
--
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
2
--
--
Basic Setup
D
JUN
--
--
--
JUN
03
--
01
--
00
M
M
M
3
D
--
8User Name
Time
&
Date
--
ON
OFF
ON
--
--
D
D
D
M
--
--
--
--
4
User Regist.
User Edit
M
M
M
M
--
M
24
--
03
--
01
--
--
--
01
--
--
--
01
--
--
00
M
M
M
M
5
OFF
D
--
--
Enter 4-14 alphanumeric characters for the user name.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to
page 54.
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
--
--
ON -- --
D
--
--
6
7
OFF
--
24
--
--
--
24
--
--
D
--
JUN
--
--
--
JUN
--
--
--
M
Y
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
03
--
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
00
--
--
--
00
--
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
--
--
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
8
9
03
--
--
--
--
--
10
--
--
OK
CANCEL
8Password
x Move the cursor to enter the ON or OFF time (year,
Enter 4-8 alphanumeric characters for the password.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to
page 54.
month, date) for summer time using the arrows button.
[Screenshot 3]
The cursor will move to the selected cell for entry of the ON
or OFF time for summer time.
Important:
Set a unique password, not something that would be
easily guessed by a third person. The password also
should be memorable.
Y
1
ON
SETUP MEN
24
--
--
--
24
--
D
D
JUN
--
M
M
M
M
M
M
03
--
--
01
--
--
H
00
M
LIVE
OFF
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
--
--
--
M
M
M
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
D
D
--
--
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
2
--
--
Basic Setup
D
JUN
--
--
--
JUN
03
--
01
--
00
M
M
M
3
D
--
Time
&
Date
--
ON
OFF
ON
--
--
D
D
D
M
--
--
--
--
4
User Regist.
User Edit
M
M
M
M
--
M
24
--
03
--
01
--
--
--
01
--
--
--
01
--
--
00
M
M
M
M
5
OFF
D
--
--
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
8Level
--
--
ON -- --
D
--
--
6
7
OFF
--
24
--
--
--
24
--
--
D
--
JUN
--
--
--
JUN
--
--
--
M
Y
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
03
--
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
00
--
--
--
00
--
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
Select a user level from the following.
Setting of operable functions in each level is described in
"User Level" (Refer to page 125).
LV1/LV2/LV3
--
--
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
8
9
03
--
--
--
--
--
10
--
--
OK
CANCEL
c Rotate the jog dial to enter the ON or OFF time (year,
8Priority
month, date) for summer time.
Assign priority (1 (lowest) to 16 (highest)) to users.
v Move the cursor to "OK" and press the SET button.
→ The ON and OFF time for summer time will be
applied and the "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)
Table" will be closed.
8Default Screen
Select a camera image to be displayed during the login
procedure from the following.
CAM1 - 16: Displays an image from the selected camera
channel.
QUAD1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 4
on a 4-split screen.
QUAD5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels 5 - 8
on a 4-split screen.
Note: When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4
and press the SET button, the setting will be can-
celed and the "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)
Table" will be closed.
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split
screen.
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.
7SCREEN: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 7 on
a 7-split screen.
ꢀ [User Regist.] Registration of a user who
operates this unit
Register user information such as the user name and pass-
word.
After filling out the user information, move the cursor to
"SET" at the lower right of the menu and press the SET but-
ton to complete registration.
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a
9-split screen.
123
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split
screen.
10SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 10 on a 10-split screen.
13SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 13 on a 13-split screen.
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.
SEQ: Images will be displayed in the sequential display.
ꢀ [Host Regist.] Registration of PC (host)
accessible to this unit
Register host information for the PC that accesses the unit
via a network such as a LAN.
Move the cursor to "SET" at the lower right on the menu and
press the SET button to complete registration.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Host IP Address
Level
Priority
Default Screen
Camera Partitioning
I
I
I
I
I
000
LV1
1
.
000
.
000
.
000
Basic Setup
Time
&
Date
User Regist.
User Edit
CAM1
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
View/Operate
CAM9
View/Operate
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
View/Operate CAM10 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM11 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM12 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM13 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM14 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM15 View/Operate
View/Operate CAM16 View/Operate
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
8Camera Partitioning
SET
Select a controllable range for each camera channel from
the following.
View/Operate: Displaying live images and operating the
camera are possible.
View: Displaying live images is possible but cameras can-
not be operated.
--: Both displaying live images and operating the camera
are impossible.
8Host IP Address
Enter the IP address. Move the cursor to "Host IP Address"
and rotate the jog dial to enter the IP address. For this unit,
enter 4 units from the decimal numbers (0-254).
Notes:
• Entering "*" validates all numbers.
• It is impossible to register "0.0.0.0" or "*.*.*.*".
ꢀ [User Edit] Correction of the registered user
information
8Level
It is possible to edit the registered user information.
Move the cursor to "User Name" and rotate the jog dial to
select the user name.
The registered information will be displayed.
Editing can be performed in the same way as registration.
(Refer to page 123.)
Select a user level from the following.
Setting of operable functions for each level is described in
"User Level" (Refer to page 125).
LV1/LV2/LV3
8Priority
Move the cursor to "EDIT" at the lower right on the menu
and press the SET button to complete editing.
Assign priority (1 (lowest) to 16 (highest)) to hosts.
8Default Screen
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Select a startup display to be displayed after login from the
following.
CAM1 - 16 (for the WJ-HD316)/CAM 1-9 (for the WJ-HD
309): Displays live images from the selected camera
channel on a single screen.
User Name
I
I
Basic Setup
Time
&
Date
User Password
User Regist.
User Edit
LV1
16
16 SCREEN
Level
Priority
Default Screen
Camera Partitioning
I
I
I
I
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
View/Operate
CAM9
View
View
View
--
--
--
View/Operate CAM10
View/Operate CAM11
View/Operate CAM12
View/Operate CAM13
View/Operate CAM14
View/Operate CAM15
View/Operate CAM16
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
QUAD1 - 4: Displays live images from camera channels 1 -
4 on a 4-split screen.
--
--
EDIT
QUAD5 - 8: Displays live images from camera channels 5 -
8 on a 4-split screen.
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split
screen.
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays live
images from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split
screen.
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays live
images from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split
screen.
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a
9-split screen.
ꢀ [User Delete] Deletion of a registered user
It is possible to delete a registered user.
Move the cursor to "User Name" and rotate the jog dial to
select the user name. Move the cursor to "DELETE" and
press the SET button.
The selected user will be deleted.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
User Name
Basic Setup
I
Time
&
Date
DELETE
User Regist.
User Edit
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
124
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split
screen.
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.
SEQ: Images will be displayed in the sequential display.
ꢀ [User Level] Setting of the operation level
Set operable functions at each user level (LV 1/LV 2/
LV 3).
Rotate the jog dial to display "b" to enable operation.
Leave it blank to disable operation.
Refer to the table on the next page for each function.
The default settings are shown as below.
8Camera Partitioning
Select a controllable range for each camera channel from
the following.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
SChedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Basic Setup
LV1 LV2 LV3
View/Operate: Displaying live images and operating the
camera are possible.
View: Displaying live images is possible but cameras can-
not be operated.
--: Both displaying live images and operating camera are
impossible.
Time
&
Date
WJ-HD300 Setup
WJ-HD300 Setup Status
Camera Setup
Event Log Status
Access Log Status
Error Log Status
Alarm Reset
Alarm Suspended Time
Copy
Normal Recording Erase
Event Recording Erase
Manual REC Operation
Playback Operation
N/W Access
User Regist.
User Edit
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
Each parameter of the user level is as follows:
LV1: Possible to perform all the operations (Administrators)
LV2: Possible to refer the settings of the unit and the
access log, and to perform the alarm reset (Head of
operators)
ꢀ [Host Edit] Correction of the registered host
information
It is possible to edit the registered host information.
Move the cursor to "Host IP Address" and rotate the jog dial
to select the host IP address.
LV3: Possible to monitor or play the images (Operators)
The registered information will be displayed.
Editing can be performed in the same way as registration.
(Refer to page 124.)
Move the cursor to "EDIT" at the lower right on the menu
and press the SET button to complete editing.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Host IP Address
Level
Priority
Default Screen
Camera Partitioning
I
I
I
I
I
000
LV1
16
.
000
.
000
.
000
Basic Setup
Time
&
Date
User Regist.
User Edit
16 SCREEN
CAM1
CAM2
CAM3
CAM4
CAM5
CAM6
CAM7
CAM8
View/Operate
CAM9
View
View
View
--
--
--
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
View/Operate CAM10
View/Operate CAM11
View/Operate CAM12
View/Operate CAM13
View/Operate CAM14
View/Operate CAM15
View/Operate CAM16
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
--
--
EDIT
ꢀ [Host Delete] Deletion of a registered host
It is possible to delete a registered host.
Move the cursor to "Host Delete" and rotate the jog dial to
select the host. Move the cursor to "DELETE" and press the
SET button.
The selected host will be deleted.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
Basic Setup
LIVE
Host IP Address
I
0. 0. 0. 0
DELETE
Time
&
Date Setup
User Regist.
User Edit
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
125
ꢀ Functions that can be enabled/disabled
The following functions can be enabled/disabled according to the user level.
Function
Description
WJ-HD300 Setup
WJ-HD300 Setup Status
Camera Setup
The SETUP MENU is displayed and the settings can be performed.
Only the SETUP MENU can be displayed. The settings cannot be performed.
The setting menu of the camera is displayed and the settings can be performed.
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the event log. (Refer to page
96.) You also can refer to the network log. Refer to the Network Operating
Instructions (PDF) for further information.
Event Log Status
Error Log Status
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the error log. (Refer to page 96.)
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the access log. (Refer to page
97.)
Access Log Status
Alarm Reset
An event operation can be canceled. (Refer to page 47.)
An event operation can be suppressed. (Refer to page 47.)
A recorded image can be manually copied. (Refer to page 48.)
Image data in the normal recording area of the hard disk can be manually deleted.
Image data in the event recording area of the hard disk can be manually deleted.
Manual recording can be started and stopped.
Alarm Suspend
Copy
Normal Recording Erase
Event Recording Erase
Manual REC Operation
Playback Operation
N/W Access
A recorded image can be played.
This unit can be logged into from a PC via a network.
ꢀ [Save/Load] Saving and loading of settings
of the SETUP MENU
It is possible to save the settings of the SETUP MENU in
this unit.
It is also possible to call up saved settings. (Load)
Move the cursor to "SAVE" or "LOAD" and press the SET
button.
Maintenance
Switcher
Recording
Display
Event
Comm
Schedule
System
SETUP MENU
LIVE
Basic Setup
User Setup Save
User Setup Load
I
I
SAVE
LOAD
Time
&
Date
User Regist.
User Edit
User Delete
Host Regist.
Host Edit
Host Delete
User Level
Save/Load
126
DISPLAY SETUP MENU OF CAMERA
For operating the camera connected to this unit, it is necessary to set the camera functions in advance.
Setup of the camera functions can be performed on the setup menu of the connected camera.
You can operate the camera setup menu by calling up it from this unit. Contents of the camera setting menu and operations
vary according to the connected cameras. For further information, refer to the operating instructions of the camera.
The following are the descriptions of how to display the camera setting menu.
z Press the camera selection button for a desired camera channel and the SET button simultaneously.
→The camera setup menu will be displayed.
Use the following buttons on the front panel to perform the settings of the camera setup menu.
To move the cursor
Arrows button (CD)
To change the selected parameter
Arrows button (AB)
To determine the selected parameter
To display the submenu
SET button
To return to the previous menu
SETUP/ESC button
x Press any one of the PAN/TILT button, the ZOOM/FOCUS button, the IRIS button, the PRESET/AUTO button and the cam-
era selection buttons 4 - 16 for the WJ-HD316 (4 - 9 for the WJ-HD309) to complete the camera setting.
Note: To display the special menu of the camera setup menu, press the camera selection button 2 after moving the cursor
to SPECIAL on the camera setup menu.
To reset the settings of the camera setup menu to the default settings, press the camera selection button 3 after mov-
ing the cursor to CAMERA RESET on the special menu.
Depending on the models of the connected cameras, the operation method and menu items are different. Refer to the
operating instructions of the connected camera.
127
DISK MANAGEMENT
I Notes on the hard disk
Camera images are recorded into the built-in hard disk of
I How to replace the built-in hard
disk
this unit.
It is possible to replace the hard disk drive regardless of
whether the power of the unit is on/off.
However, the procedures for replacement are different.
Refer to the operating instructions for the optional extension
unit when replacing the hard disk in the extension unit.
There are two hard disks in this unit. In case one of them
malfunctions during recording, it is possible to keep record-
ing with the other hard disk (mirror function).
The internal hard disk of this unit is virtually divided into 3
areas to manage the hard disk.
Normal recording area: An area into which images are
recorded at times other than an event occurrence such
as manual recording.
Event recording area: An area into which images are
recorded at an event occurrence.
When replacing the hard disk drive after turn-
ing off the power of the unit.
z Turn off the power of the unit and detach the power
plug from the outlet.
Copy area: An area into which copy data is stored.
x Do the following to replace the hard disk drive.
It is possible to check the available disk space for each
area on "Disk Info" of "Maintenance" on the SETUP MENU.
(Refer to page 94.)
• When connecting an optional extension unit (WJ-
HDE300 series), it is possible to create a pre-recording
area to perform pre-event recording (page 135) for up
to 60 minutes.
1. Open the connectors cover on the front panel and
remove the fixing screws.
Detach the front panel by sliding it after removing the
screws.
Operations for the hard disk drive such as initialization (for-
matting) of the hard disk drive in the unit or the optional
extension unit, or mirroring, etc., can be performed in the
"HDD DISK MENU". (Refer to page 131.)
Note: It is necessary to create either the normal recording
area or the event record area. If the normal recording
area is not created, manual recording images and
schedule recording images are recorded into the event
recording area. If the event recording area is not creat-
ed, event recording images and emergency recording
images are recorded into the normal recording area.
Screw
Connectors cover
Important:
• Do not detach the cable connecting the unit and the
front panel while the HDD status indicators are still lit or
until 30 seconds have passed since the HDD status
indicators went off.
• Protect the hard disk drives from static electricity.
• Do not stack them, or keep them upright.
• Do not use an electric screwdriver to fix them.
(Tightening torque: Approx. 0.49 N · m (5 kgf · cm))
• Avoid rapid changes in the temperature/humidity to
prevent condensation. (Acceptable change: within
15°C/h (59 °F/h))
128
2. Remove the cable from the front panel.
5. Detach the flat cable and the power supply cable from
the hard disk drive. Detach the flat cable only from the
hard disk drive. (Do not detach the flat cable from the
circuit board.)
When pulling the flat cable to detach from the hard disk
drive, hold the pull-ring on the connector, not cable.
Otherwise, it may cause breaking of wire.
After detaching the cables, remove the screw on point
A.
Front panel
connector
Then, remove the four screws fixing the lower hard disk
drive.
When removing, hold the hard disk drive securely to
prevent it from falling.
After removing the four screws, detach the hard disk
drive from the hard disk drive mounting angle.
3. Remove the screws fixing the mounting unit, and then
pull the hard disk drive mounting angle toward you.
Screw removed from
point A
Hold these
tabs and pull
Connector of the
power supply cable
Screw removed from point A
D
S
S
D
S
S
Screws
SSD
Only the upper and lower holes on both sides will be
used when fixing by screws even though there are 3
holes each on both sides.
Screws for the lower hard disk drive
(4 screws: 2 screws each
on the both sides)
4. Remove the four screws fixing the upper hard disk
drive.
Hard disk drive mounting angle
When removing, hold the hard disk drive securely to
prevent it from falling.
Then, detach the flat cable from the hard disk drive and
detach the hard disk drive from the hard disk mounting
angle.
6. Install the new hard disk drive in the reverse order used
for detaching the hard disk drive.
Confirm that the hard disk drive is set as master using
the jumper connector.
Jumper pin
Important:
Power supply
Pull-ring
cable
• When installing, confirm that there is no dust around the
connectors. Adhesion of dust may cause malfunction.
• The jumper connector setting differs depending on the
models or the manufacturers. Refer to the indication
label or the operating instructions of the used hard disk
drive.
Flat cable
Connector
SSD
• Attach the connector and the screws firmly. Otherwise,
it may cause problems.
c After replacing the hard disk drive, insert the power
plug into the outlet and turn on the power of the unit.
→ The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automati-
cally after the restart.
Screws for the upper
hard disk drive
(4 screws: 2 screws each
on the both sides)
Hard disk drive mounting angle
129
When replacing the hard disk drive without
turning off the power of the unit.
ꢀ When replacing the built-in hard disk of the
extension unit
With displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window, start
replacing the built-in hard disk of the optional extension
unit.
Refer to the operating instructions of the optional extension
unit for the descriptions of how to replace the hard disk.
z Close the SETUP MENU after selecting "ON" for "HDD
Safety Mode" of "Disk Info" on the "Maintenance" menu.
→ The HDD SAFETY MODE window will be displayed.
c After completing the replacement of the hard disk,
move the cursor to "OFF" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
→ The unit will restart and the HDD DISK MENU will be
displayed automatically.
v Perform the settings for the disk according to your
x The procedures are different between the replacement
of the hard disk of the unit and the replacement of the
hard disk of the optional extension unit.
needs. Refer to page 133 for further information.
When replacing the built-in hard disk of the unit
Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button and
press the SET button.
The "REMOVE" indication will change to "REMOVING".
The power supply to the front panel will be cut and the unit
cannot be operated with the front panel.
Detach the cable from the front panel and start replacing
the built-in hard disk.
Start from step 2 on page 128 to replace the built-in hard
disk.
Important:
Detach the cable from the front panel after confirming
that "REMOVING" is displayed. Otherwise, it may cause
malfunction.
The "REMOVING" indication will return to "REMOVE" by
attaching the cable to the front panel. The power will be
supplied to the front panel and the unit can be operated
with the front panel.
130
I About the HDD DISK MENU
The operations regarding the hard disk can be performed by displaying the "HDD DISK MENU" on monitor 2.
The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed when the SET button is pressed while displaying the system check complete window.
The "HDD DISK MENU" will also be displayed automatically after replacing or removing the hard disk.
The following operations can be performed on the "HDD DISK MENU".
Setting item
FORMAT
Description
Page
133
Formats (initializes) the hard disk. It can also change the setting values for
the recording area respectively. Mirroring can also be started on this menu.
MIRROR ON
MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
Recovers the mirrored hard disk.
Cancels mirroring.
138
138
139
–
Removes the hard disk drive from the system logically.
Restarts this unit.
Closes the "HDD DISK MENU".
–
I Display of the HDD DISK MENU
Information of the hard disk drive of the unit or the optional extension unit will be displayed on the "HDD DISK MENU".
Main unit/optional extension unit
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
Information about hard disk located in the main unit and optional exten-
sion unit
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
160 GB: Indicates the hard disk capacity (disk existed
when last started up)
ERROR: Indicates that the hard disk has failed to be initial-
ized.
160 GB M: Indicates the hard disk capacity (mirrored disk
existed when last started up)
Important:
ADD (160 GB): Indicates that this hard disk is newly mount-
ed at this startup, but that it was not mounted last time.
Those parenthesized numbers indicate the capacity of
the hard disk.
• It is impossible to operate the unit when there is a hard
disk with indications of * (capacity), * (ERROR), LOST
or ERROR. In this case, remove the relevant hard disk.
(Refer to page 139.)
ADD (ERROR): Indicates that this hard disk is newly
mounted at this startup, but that it was not mounted last
time. Then, an error is detected on the hard disk.
* (160 GB): Indicates that a different hard disk from the one
that existed at the last startup is mounted. Those paren-
thesized numbers indicate the capacity of the hard
disk.
* (ERROR): Indicates that a different hard disk from the one
that existed at the last startup is mounted, and an error
has been detected on the hard disk.
• Hard disks with ADD (capacity) indication are not initial-
ized yet.
First, initialize them. It is impossible to record images on
it or to use it as a copy destination without initialization.
Note: The displayed available disk space on this menu will
not include the space required for data management.
Therefore, the understated available disk space will be
displayed.
It is possible to display information about the recording
area (allocated disk size for normal recording area,
event recording area and copy area) by pressing the
SETUP/ESC button while displaying the "TOP MENU" of
the "HDD DISK MENU".
LOST: Indicates that a position where a hard disk was
mounted at the last startup has no hard disk.
–: Indicates that a hard disk is not mounted this time nor
was it at the last startup.
131
I RAID 5 Function of the Extension Unit
Summary of the RAID 5 function (Redundant
Arrays for Independent Disks, independent
data disks with distributed parity blocks)
ꢀ Setup/cancel the RAID 5 function
Do the following to set or cancel the RAID 5 function with an
optional extension unit.
Refer to the operating instructions of the extension unit for
further information.
It is possible to use the RAID 5 function with an optional
extension unit.
RAID level 5 regards 3 or more drives as one drive, and it is
possible to read data by attaching error correction data
even though one of the drives is broken automatically. (It is
impossible to recover data if two drives are simultaneously
damaged or the second drive fails during the data recovery
process.)
RAID level 5 requires a minimum of 3 drives to implement.
When using the RAID function, the logical disk size of the
extension unit will be as below.
z Make sure that the power of this unit and all of the
extension units to be connected is OFF.
x To set the RAID 5 function, set the mode switch of the
extension unit to "RAID 5".
To cancel the RAID 5 function, set the mode switch of
the extension unit to "SINGLE".
c Make sure that the HDD POWER switch of the extension
Logical disk size = Smallest size of the disk among the
disks in the extension unit x (Number of the disks in the
extension unit - 1)
unit is "ON".
v Turn the power of the extension unit on.
Note: Depending on the model of a hard disk drive, the
logical disk size may be a few percent smaller than the
size resulting from the formula above.
b Turn the power of this unit on.
→ The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automati-
cally after the system check when the hard disk
configuration has been changed such as when an
extension unit is newly connected.
Important:
• When connecting two extension units or more with this
unit, it is impossible to connect the extension unit with
the RAID 5 function and the one without the RAID 5
function at the same time.
• When the RAID 5 function is used, it is impossible to
use two hard disks in this unit. The recorded pictures in
those disks will not be deleted.
Important:
• When the RAID 5 function is set or canceled, all data on
each hard disk of the extension unit will be deleted.
• When turning the power on, turn on the power of the
extension unit first, and then turn the power of this unit
on. Otherwise, the extension unit may not work correct-
ly.
132
v Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the
jog dial.
I Formatting (Initialization) the
Hard Disk
It is necessary to initialize the hard disk in the following
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for password.
cases.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
• When replacing the hard disk of this unit
• When operating the unit for the first time after connect-
ing the optional extension unit to this unit
b Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
Important:
(CD) and press the SET button.
When the hard disk is formatted (initialized), all of the
recorded images will be deleted.
[Screenshot 3]
The "THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu will be dis-
played.
ꢀ Formatting (initialization) all hard
disks (unit)
All hard disks including the built-in hard disks and the hard
disks in the extension units will be initialized. All units will be
initialized when the RAID 5 function is set.
Digital Disk Recorder
HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
*(ERROR)
z Turn on the power of any peripheral devices such as an
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
extension unit connected to this unit.
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
x Turn on the power of this unit and press the SET button
after completing the system check.
n Move the cursor to "ALL UNITS" using the arrows button
(AB) and press the SET button.
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-
matically displayed.
Select "ALL UNITS" when using the RAID 5 function.
Digital Disk Recorder
HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
ALL UNIT ONE UNIT
[Screenshot 1]
MAIN
-
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
EXT1 480GB
EXT2 480GB
EXT3 480GB
EXT4 *(480GB)
EXT5 ADD (480GB)
EXT6 480GB
EXT7 LOST
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[Screenshot 4]
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
The "RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISKS" will be dis-
played.
c Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
DWigitaJl -HD300
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISK
Normal area
90GB
Event area
1800GB
Copy area
450GB
Free area
450GB
[Screenshot 2]
The password entry window will be displayed.
HDD Total capacity : 2790GB
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.
160GB
-
m Select a recording area using the arrows button (A B)
and rotate the jog dial to set the capacity for the select-
ed recording area.
EXECUTE CANCEL
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Repeat this operation to set the capacity for the other
recording areas.
133
[Screenshot 2]
, Press the SET button after setting.
The password entry window will be displayed.
[Screenshot 5]
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
Disk Recorder
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
DWigitaJl -HD300
HDD DISK MENU
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISK
Enter the password.
160GB
-
Normal aea
9
veaea
y aea
ee aea
EXECUTE
CANCEL
Starting format of all HDDs,
EXT5 A
and all of data in HDDs
are going to be erased.
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
EXECUTE CANCEL
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
v Rotate the jog dial to enter the password for an admin-
istrator.
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for password.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
. Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
→ Formatting will start and the format result dialog
window will be displayed. The "TOP MENU" of the
"HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automatically
after displaying the format result dialog window.
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (C D)
and press the SET button.
ꢀ Formatting (initialization) the
selected hard disk (unit)
[Screenshot 3]
The "THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu will be dis-
played.
Do the following to format the selected hard disk (the
selected unit when using the RAID 5 function).
z Turn on the power of any peripheral devices such as an
Digital Disk Recorder
HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
extension unit connected to this unit.
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB
160GB
160GB
x Turn on the power of this unit.
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
An image saying that the system check has been com-
pleted will be displayed.
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played automatically.
Digital Disk Recorder
HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
ALL UNIT
ONE UNIT
MAIN
-
EXT1 480GB
EXT2 480GB
EXT3 480GB
EXT4 *(480GB)
EXT5 ADD (480GB)
EXT6 480GB
EXT7 LOST
[Screenshot 1]
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
n Move the cursor to "SELECTED DISK" using the arrows
button (A B) and press the SET button.
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
When using the RAID 5 function, select "ONE UNIT" on
"THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu.
c Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
134
[Screenshot 4]
, Select a setting method for each recording area from
the following using the arrows button (A B) and press
the SET button.
The "DISK SELECT" menu will be displayed.
When using the RAID 5 function, the "UNIT SELECTION"
menu will be displayed.
Auto Setup: Assigns the same proportion for each
recording area as the proportion of the existing
hard disks. (→ step 9)
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT DISK SELECT
All Copy Area: Sets the whole selected hard disk (unit)
Select HDD to be formatted,and press [SET]key.
1
160GB M
160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
2
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
3
4
as the copy area. (→ step 9)
MAIN
EXT1
160GB
160GB
All Pre REC Area: Sets the whole selected hard disk
(extension unit) as the pre-recording area. (→ step
10)
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
Detailed Setup: Sets each recording area individually.
(→ step 11)
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Important:
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT UNIT SELECTION
When the built-in hard disk of this unit is selected, "All
Pre REC Area" is not available.
Select HDD to be formatted,and press [SET] key.
MAIN
EXT1
-
480GB
EXT2 480GB
EXT3 480GB
EXT4 *(480GB)
EXT5 ADD (480GB)
EXT6 480GB
EXT7 LOST
[Screenshot 6]
The confirmation menu of the set recording area will be dis-
played.
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
AUTO SETUP
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>
Normal area
10GB
Event area
80GB
Copy area
35GB
Free area
35GB
m Move the cursor to a desired hard disk (unit) to be for-
matted (initialized) using the arrows button and press
the SET button.
HDD Total capacity:160GB
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
[Screenshot 5]
"THE SETTING METHOD" menu will be displayed.
<Screen displayed when selecting "AUTO SETUP">
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SELECT
THE SETTING METHOD
Auto Setup All Copy Area All Pre REC Area Detailed Setup
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
ALL COPY AREA
1
160GB M
160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
2
3
4
MAIN
EXT1
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
Normal area
0GB
Event area
0GB
Copy area
160GB
Free area
0GB
160GB
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
HDD Total capacity:160GB
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
DISK SELECT THE SETTING METHOD
WJ-HD300
<Screen displayed when selecting "ALL COPY AREA">
Auto Setup All Copy Area All Pre REC Area Detailed Setup
MAIN
-
EXT1
480GB
. Confirm the capacity of the set recording area and
press the SET button.
EXT2 480GB
EXT3 480GB
EXT4 *(480GB)
EXT5 ADD (480GB)
EXT6 480GB
→ The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
(→ step 13)
EXT7 LOST
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>
135
[Screenshot 7]
[Screenshot 9]
The "PRE RECORDING AREAS" menu will be displayed.
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
PRE RECORDING AREAS
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
DETAILED SETUP
1CH
0GB
2CH
0GB
3CH
0GB
4CH
0GB
5CH
0GB
6CH
0GB
7CH
0GB
8CH
0GB
Normal aea
1
Event aea
Coy aea Fee aea
Starting one (1) disk formatting.
All of contents in the disk is erased.
9CH
0GB
10CH
0GB
11CH
0GB
12CH
0GB
13CH
0GB
14CH
0GB
15CH
0GB
16CH
0GB
FREE
0GB
EXECUTE
CANCEL
HDD Total capacity:160GB
[
]
[
]
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
⁄ Select the camera channel for pre-event recording
using the arrows button and assign the disk space to
the selected pre-recording area by rotating the jog dial.
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or
more camera channels.
⁄ Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
→ Formatting will start and the "TOP MENU" of the
"HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed.
Press the SET button after setting.
→ The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
(→ step 13)
Important:
It is impossible to select the camera channel to which
the pre-recording area on another hard disk (extension
unit) is already assigned.
[Screenshot 8]
The "DETAILED SETUP" menu will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
DETAILED SETUP
Normal area
110GB
Event area
0GB
Copy area
0GB
Free area
50GB
HDD Total capacity:160GB
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
⁄ Select the recording area using the arrows button and
assign the disk space to the selected recording area by
rotating the jog dial.
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or
more recording areas.
Press the SET button after setting.
⁄ Press the SET button after setting.
136
I Setting for Mirroring
Mirroring is the function that records camera images onto
two hard disks simultaneously. In case one hard disk has a
problem, image data will be stored on the other hard disk.
The credibility of the disk can be enhanced.
[Screenshot 2]
The password entry window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
It is recommended to activate the mirroring function for the
first use of this unit.
When the mirroring function is activated with remaining
recorded images in the hard disk, those recorded images
in the hard disk will be deleted.
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
4
MAIN
EXT1
EXT2
EXT3
EXT4 *
Enter the password.
160GB
-
EXECUTE CANCEL
EXT5
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Important:
• The mirroring function can be configured only by two of
the built-in hard disks.
• The size of the two hard disks used for the mirroring
function must be the same.
• When using the RAID 5 function, it is impossible to acti-
vate the mirroring function.
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the
jog dial.
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for the password.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
ꢀ Start mirroring
Do the following to activate the mirroring function.
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
(CD) and press the SET button.
z Turn on the power of this unit.
An image saying that the system check has been com-
pleted will be displayed.
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.
[Screenshot 3]
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder
HDD DISK MENU
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-
matically displayed.
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
*(ERROR)
[Screenshot 1]
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
b Move the cursor to "MIRROR FORMAT" using the
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
arrows button (CD) and press the SET button.
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
[Screenshot 4]
The "MIRROR AREA SETUP" menu will be displayed.
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK SETTING METHOD
MIRROR AREA SETUP
Normal area
10GB
Event area
90GB
Copy area
30GB
Free area
30GB
x Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
HDD Total capacity:160GB
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
137
[Screenshot 2]
The password entry window will be displayed.
n Select a recording area using the arrows button and
assign the disk space to the selected recording area by
rotating the jog dial.
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or
more recording areas.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.
160GB
-
m Press the SET button after setting.
EXECUTE CANCEL
EXT5 A
[Screenshot 5]
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
, Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the
jog dial.
→ Mirroring will start and the "TOP MENU" of the "HDD
DISK MENU" will be displayed.
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for password.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300
DISK CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT
MIRROR AREA SETUP
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
No
Starting mirror format of HDDs
in main unit, and all of data
in HDDs are going to be erased.
EXECUTE
CANCEL
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
(CD) and press the SET button.
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET
[Screenshot 3]
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
ꢀ Cancel mirroring (MIRROR OFF)
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
Do the following to cancel the mirroring function.
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
3
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
4
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *(
z Turn on the power of this unit.
Mirror "OFF" in main unit.
160GB
160GB
-
An image saying that the system check has been com-
pleted will be displayed.
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.
OK
CANCEL
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Close the information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-
matically displayed.
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (A B)
and press the SET button.
→ Mirroring will be canceled.
[Screenshot 1]
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
Note: One of the two hard disks involved in mirroring
will be indicated as "* (capacity)" on the "TOP
MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" after canceling the
mirroring function.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
ꢀ Hard disk recovery (MIRROR ON)
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
Do the following to recover the hard disk when one of the
hard disks involved in mirroring is damaged while mirroring,
or when one of the hard disks is replaced.
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
By completing the following procedures, recovery of the
hard disk will start when the unit is in operation after the
HDD DISK MENU is closed.
x Move the cursor to "MIRROR OFF" using the arrows but-
ton (A B) and press the SET button.
z Turn on the power of this unit.
An image saying that the system check has been com-
pleted will be displayed.
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.
138
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-
matically displayed.
[Screenshot 3]
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
[Screenshot 1]
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
M
i
rr
o
r
"ON" in m
a
in
u
nit.
160GB
160GB
-
OK
CANCEL
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
*(ERROR)
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (A B)
and press the SET button.
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
→ Recovery of the hard disk will start when the unit is
in operation after the "HDD DISK MENU" is closed.
x Move the cursor to "MIRROR ON" using the arrows but-
ton (A B) and press the SET button.
ꢀ Remove the Hard Disk Logically and
Reconfigure it (REMOVE)
Note: When it is impossible to recover the hard disk
(mirror on) such in case that the hard disk size to be
recovered is too small, it is impossible to select
"MIRROR ON".
It is possible to remove the hard disk logically (unmount)
without uninstalling (detaching) the hard disk physically. It
is recommended to remove the hard disk logically when the
hard disk of the unit or an extension unit is having trouble
(hard disk indicated with "*", "LOST" or "ERROR") and it is
necessary to remove it temporarily but not to stop opera-
tion.
[Screenshot 2]
The password entry window will be displayed.
Do the following to remove the hard disk logically.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
3
RESTART
EXIT
z Turn on the power of this unit.
1
2
4
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
An image saying that the system check has been com-
pleted will be displayed.
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.
Enter the password.
160GB
-
EXECUTE CANCEL
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-
matically displayed.
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the
jog dial.
[Screenshot 1]
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played.
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for password.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M
EXT1 160GB
EXT2 160GB
EXT3 160GB
EXT4 *(160GB)
160GB M
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
160GB
-
160GB
160GB
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button
*(ERROR)
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB
(CD) and press the SET button.
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
x Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button
(A B) and press the SET button.
139
[Screenshot 2]
The password entry window will be displayed.
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU
FORMAT
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF
REMOVE
RESTART
EXIT
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.
160GB
-
EXECUTE CANCEL
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB
EXT7 LOST
160GB
-
160GB
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the
jog dial.
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to
enter numbers for password.
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete
characters as for attaching text information to images.
Refer to page 54.
→ The hard disk will be removed logically and the
confirmation dialog window will be displayed.
[Screenshot 3]
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed after logi-
cal remove of the hard disk is started.
Digital Disk Recorder
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU REMOVING
HDD DISK MENU
REMOVING
MAIN : REMOVED OK
EXT1–4 : REMOVED OK
EXT2–1 : REMOVED OK
EXT2–2 : REMOVED OK
EXT5–3 : REMOVED OK
EXT6–1 : REMOVED OK
EXT6–2 : REMOVED OK
EXT6–3 : REMOVED OK
EXT6–4 : REMOVED OK
EXT7–1 : REMOVED OK
v The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-
played when logical remove has been completed.
140
SERIAL (RS232C) CONNECTOR COMMAND REFERENCE
I SERIAL (RS232C) Communication Protocol
With the SERIAL (RS232C) interface, you can control functions of this unit by transferring the specified commands from a per-
sonal computer (PC) to this unit.
Notes:
• This unit does not support the communication converted between the SERIAL (RS232C) and USB interface.
• When controlling the unit with the SERIAL (RS232C) interface, the following parameters should be identical between the
communication devices.
The setting is available in "SETUP MENU" – "Comm" – " SERIAL (RS232C) Setting".
Baud Rate
Data Bit
Parity
Stop Bit
I Command Format
The following pages detail how to write the commands.
1. The following details how to write the commands
Code
ASCII
[STX] AD [Unit address of this unit] [Transmission Command] : [p] [ETX]
(02H) – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – (03H)
STX: This shows the data start. STX (ASCII code: 02h) is always prefixed to data. h shows hexadecimal digit.
Transmission command: A command shown in the Command List is designated.
ETX: This shows the data end. ETX (ASCII code: 03h) is always prefixed to data.
The character code is ASCII.
When a command needs a parameter, a colon (:) is used for dividing the command and parameter. The following shows
how to write the commands when two or more commands are specified.
Code
[STX] AD [Unit address of this unit] [Transmission Command] : [p1] : [p2] [ETX]
2. Response Command (from the Unit to the PC)
The unit sends back the response command for the transmission command from the PC.
• When the reception was completed successfully
The response command differs between when an ANSWER command (sending back the status or data) is required or
when not required.
• When no ANSWER command is required
The unit sends back the same identifier as that in the transmission command, as shown in the figure.
Transmission command (→ The unit)
Response command (← The unit)
[STX]
OPL
[ETX]
[STX]
OPL
[ETX]
Same identifier
141
• When an ANSWER command is required
The unit sends back the status or data, as shown in the figure.
Transmission command (→ The unit)
Response command (← The unit)
[STX]
QOP
[ETX]
[STX]
OPL
[ETX]
Status inquiry command
Status information command
Transmission command (→ The unit)
Response command (← The unit)
[STX]
QRV
[ETX]
[STX]
QRV:1.01:1.01:1.00:1.10 [ETX]
Version inquiry command
Sends back data.
• About ACK code
After receiving a command from the PC, the unit sends back the ACK code to the PC in 20 ms or less.
[ACK] = Reception succeeded (ASCII code: 06H)
After the ACK code has been sent back and the command processing has been completed, the unit sends back the
response command to the PC.
Example:
These are examples for the following operations.
1. Login with the user name of "ADMIN" and with password of "12345".
2. Display images from camera channel 1 on monitor 2.
3. Start playback from the point of January 1 2003, 3:00 p.m.
4. Logout
(1) (This unit -> PC) Login
[STX]AD001;OLI:ADMIN[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]
[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]:12345[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]
[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP][ETX]
When receiving the command above, this unit will start the login procession of the user name of "ADMIN".
(2) (This unit -> PC) Response against (1).
[STX]AD001;OLI:1[ETX]
(3) (PC -> This unit) Select the monitor 2
[STX]AD001;OMS:001[ETX]
(4) (This unit -> PC) Response against (3).
[STX]AD001;OLI:1[ETX]
(5) (PC -> This unit) Display images from the camera channel 1.
[STX]AD001;OCS:00001[ETX]
(6) (This unit - > PC) Response against (5).
[STX]AD001;OCS:00002[ETX]
(7) (PC -> This unit) Playback from the designated time point.
[STX]AD001;ZTP:20030101150000[ETX]
When receiving the command above, this unit will start playback from the point of January 1 2003, 3:00 p.m.
(8) (This unit - > PC) Response against (7).
[STX]AD001;ZTP: 200301011500000[ETX]
142
(9) (PC -> This unit) Logout.
[STX]AD001;OLO [ETX]
When receiving the command above, the user logged in via SERIAL (RS232C) (ADMIN) will log out.
(10)(This unit - > PC) Response against (9).
[STX]AD001;OLO[ETX]
Note: The character code of [STX], [ETX] and [SP] are as follows.
[STX]: 02h
[ETX]: 03h
[SP] (space): 20h
3. Reception Error
The response command differs between the reception error and parameter error.
• Communication error (Reception error)
When the unit cannot properly receive the command due to the communication error, the unit immediately sends back the
NACK code to the PC. After clearing the receive buffer, the unit enters the wait state until receiving the following [STX]
command.
[NCK] = Reception failed (ASCII code: 15H)
N
Reason for the communication error
1: Parity error (ASCII code: 31H)
2: Framing error (ASCII code: 33H)
3: Overrun error (ASCII code: 34H)
• Parameter error
When the unit cannot properly process the received command, the unit sends back an error code to the PC. After clearing
the receive buffer, the unit enters the wait state until receiving the following [STX] command.
ER
N
[ETX]
=Error
Reason for the error
001: Command invalid (There is no associated command.)
002: Parameter invalid (The number, digit, or range of the command
parameters is incorrect.)
003: Command invalid (The unit does not support the operation mode.)
E: Command error (ASCII code: 45H)
• If the unit receives another command during the response, the unit will respond to the command after processing the cur-
rent response.
• If the unit received the [STX] command again before receiving the [ETX] command, the unit will clear the internal buffer.
Then, the unit will process the data following to the [STX] command. (The commands received before the second [STX]
command will be canceled.)
• The internal buffer will be cleared when it fills up.*
143
4. PC Connection Example
An RS232C crossing cable is used for connection between the unit and PC. (Refer to the following page for cable specifica-
tion.)
D-sub Pin 9
(Female)
D-sub Pin 9
(Female)
1
SIGNAL GND
3
1
MODE
COPY
1
SERIAL
ALARM
2
1
CASCADE
OUT
4
2
POWER
AC IN
2
AUDIO IN
AUDIO OUT
15
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN
MONITOR (VGA)
ALARM/CONTOROL
8
DATA
RS485(CAMERA)
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE
16
14
14
13
12
11
10
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN
PC
OUT
16
15
13
12
11
10
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO
This unit
As viewed from the rear of the
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
5
1
Pin No. Signal Name
I/O
Cross cable connection example
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
CD
TXD
RXD
DTR
SG
IN
IN
7 (RTS)
8 (CTS)
3 (TXD)
5 (GND)
2 (RXD)
7 (RTS)
8 (CTS)
3 (TXD)
5 (GND)
2 (RXD)
9
6
OUT
OUT
–
DSR
RTS
CTS
RI
IN
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309
PC or another device
OUT
IN
IN
144
Basic Operation
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Forward a field
Rewind a field
Pause during playback
Play
Manual recording
Manual recording with
text
OVF
OVR
OPA
OPL
ORC
OVF
OVR
OPA
OPL
ORC
ZMR:nn
...
ZMR:nn:ddd ddd
nn=01~99 (Sequence number)
...
ddd ddd: text (200 bytes or less)
Stop
OSP:n
OSP
OSF
n=P: Stops PLAY
n=R: Stops REC
no parameter stops PLAY and REC
n=0F Normal speed
n=1F x2 speed
Skip & play forward
OSF:n
n=2F x5 speed
n=3F x10 speed
n=4F x20 speed
n=5F x50 speed
n=6F x100 speed
n=0S Normal speed
n=1S 1/2 speed
Skip&play reversely
OSR:n
OSR
n=0F Normal speed
n=1F x2 speed
n=2F x5 speed
n=3F x10 speed
n=4F x20 speed
n=5F x50 speed
n=6F x100 speed
n=0S Normal speed
n=1S 1/2 speed
Record No. Search and
playback
Time & date search and
playback
ZPR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:mm
ZTP:yyyymmddhhnnss
OSK:dnn
ZPR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr
ZTP:yyyymmddhhnnss
OSK
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr Record No.
yyyymmddhhnnss:Time & date of playback
image
d=+ Forward
Record skip
– Backward
nn=01 Number of skipped records: Fixed
LISTED Playback
ZLT:n
ZPM
ZLT:n
n=0 OFF
n=1 ON
Playback latest image
A - B repeat playback
ZPM
ZRP:n
ZRP:n:yyyymmddhhnnss
n=0 A - B repeat playback OFF
n=1 Set repeat start point (A point)
n=2 Set repeat end point (B point)
yyyymmddhhnnss: Date and time of A/B point
n=0 COPY SETUP MENU OFF
n=1 COPY SETUP MENU ON
n=0 Text display OFF
n=1 Text display ON
Display COPY SETUP
MENU
Display text
ZPD:n
ZDT:n
OTC:m
ZPD:n
ZDT:n
OTC:m
Multi-screen switching
m=0 4-split screen
m=1 7-split screen
m=2 9-split screen
m=3 10-split screen
m=4 13-split screen
m=5 16-split screen
nnnn=0001 Select MON 1
nnnn=0002 Select MON 2
Monitor selection
Camera selection
OMS:nnnn
OCS:ccccc
OMS:nnnn
OCS:ccccc
ccccc: Camera CH
145
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Electronic zooming
OZM:m
OZM:n
m=0 Electronic zooming OFF
m=1 Electronic zooming ON
m=> Switch x2 -> x4
m=< Switch x4 -> x2
m=+ Switch Electronic zooming OFF -> x2 ->
x4 -> Electronic zooming OFF -> ...
m=- Switch x4 -> x2 -> Electronic zooming OFF
-> x4 -> ...
n=0 Electronic zooming OFF
n=2 x2
n=4 x4 term
Start sequence
Stop sequence
Disk selection
OQT:01F
OQS:0
ZDS:k
OQT:01F:01
OQS
ZDS:k
k=0 HDD normal/event recording sector
k=1 HDD copy sector
k=2 Disk connected to COPY 1
k=3 Disk connected to COPY 2)
Marking
ZMP
ZMP
Alarm Control
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Alarm input
OAI:b1b2b3a1a2a3a4
OAI
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)
Alarm input with text
ZAI:b1b2b3a1a2a3a4:
nn:ddd ddd
ZAI:nn
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)
nn=01 - 99 (Sequence No)
...
...
ddd ddd: text (200 bytes or less)
Alarm reset
OAL;n
MAD:n
–
OAL
n=0 Alarm all reset
n=1 Alarm reset
n=0 Alarm suspension OFF
n=1 Alarm suspension ON)
n=0 LED OFF
n=1 LED ON
Alarm suspension
MAD:n
ALD:n
Alarm change information
(LED indication)
n=2 LED Blinking
Alarm change information
–
ALM: b1b2b3a1a2a3a4
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)
Setup Control
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Display SETUP MENU
MSU:n
MSU:n
n=0 SETUP MENU OFF
n=1 SETUP MENU ON
Move cursor
DCR:n1n2
DCR
n1n2=A1 Right
n1n2=C1 Upward
n1n2=E1 Left
n1n2=G1 Downward
n1n2=+1 Increment parameter (+)
n1n2=-1 Decrement parameter (–)
n1n2=PD Move to virtual menu (SET)
n1n2=P- Go back to an older page (BACK)
n1n2=PU Move to upper layer (ESC)
Date & Time setup
Summer time setup
Recording mode setup
TSU:yyyymmddhhnn
MST:n
MRM:n
TSU
MST
MRM
yyyymmddhhnn: Date and time
n=0 Standard time n=1 Summer time
n=0 Normal recording mode
n=2 Continuous (External timer) recording
mode
Login/Logout
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Login
OLI:uuu...uuu:
ppp ppp
OLI:n
uuu...uuu: User name (32-byte fixed length)
ppp...ppp: Password (32-byte fixed length)
n=0 Error in user name/password
n=1 Login succeeded
...
n=2 Login failed
Logout
OLO
OLO
146
Data Control
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Copy by specifying
record
ZCR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:m
ZCR
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2
Copy by specifying date ZCT:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1
ZCT
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1: Start date & time of
data copy
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2: End date & time of
data copy
& time
h1h1n1n1:y2y2y2y2m2m2
d2d2h2h2n2n2:s:ccc:m
s=0 Format to specify the camera CH. Fixed to
0
ccc: Camera CH No. of target for data copy
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2
Data copy completed
–
ZEC:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1
h1h1n1n1:
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1 Start date & time of
data copy
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2
n2n2:s:ccc:m
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2 End date & time of
data copy
s=0 Format to specify the camera CH. Fixed to
0
ccc: Camera CH No. of target for data copy
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2
Cancel data copy
Erase log
ZDC
ZLC:k
ZDC
ZLC:k
k=1 Event input log
k=2 Trouble log
k=3 Access log
Log data total number
inquiry
ZLQ:k:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1
h1h1n1n1:y2y2y2y2m2m2
d2d2h2h2n2n2
ZLQ:k:y1y1y1y1m1m1
d1d1h1h1n1n1
y2y2y2y2m2m2
k=0 Record list
k=1 Event input log
k=2 Trouble log
d2d2h2h2n2n2:dddddddd
k=3 (Access log)
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1: Start date & time of
inquiry range
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2: End date & time of
inquiry range
dddddddd: Log data total number
Log readout
ZLR:yyyymmdd
hhnn:mmmmmmmm
ZLR:k:<Log Data
1>s1:<Log Data
2>s2: :<Log Data
k=1 (Event input log)
k=2 (Trouble log)
k=3 (Access log)
...
n>sn
yyyymmddhhnn Start date & time of readout
logs
mmmmmmmm: Total number of acquired logs
(00000000 - 00000050)
<Log Data n>: Log data
sn: 0-9 Cyclic number
Record list acquisition
ZGR:yyyymmddnn
:nnnnnnnn
ZGR<Log Data
1>s1:<Log Data
2>s2: :<Log Data n>sn
yyyymmddhhnn: Start date & time of readout
list
mmmmmmmm: Total record number in the
acquired list (00000001 - 00000050)
<Log Data n>: Log data
...
sn: 0-9 Cyclic number
Text acquisition
Text writing
ZGT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr
ZGT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: <TEXT>
ZPT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.
<TEXT>: text data
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.
ZPT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: <TEXT>
<TEXT>: text data 200 bytes or less
Disk End Notification
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Disk end auto-notification MDE:n
setting
MDE:n
n=0 (Auto-notification OFF)
n=1 (Auto-notification ON)
Disk end auto-notification HDE:–
HDE:p
p=1 (Normal recording sector)
p=2 (Event recording sector)
p=3 (Copy sector)
147
Search Operation
Item
Display search editing
area
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
ZTL:n ZTL:n
Parameter (ASCII)
n=0 (Search editing area OFF)
n=1 (Recording event search list ON)
n=2 (Recording event search thumbnail ON)
n=3 (VMD search list ON)
n=4 (VMD Search Thumbnail OFF)
n=5 (Marking search list ON)
n=6 (Marking search thumbnail ON)
n=7 (Search playback display ON)
Display Operation
Item
Switch display
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
DIN:n DIN
Parameter (ASCII)
n=+
Inquiry
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Additional disk space
inquiry
QHR:p
QHR:p:sss
p=1 HDD normal recording sector
p=2 HDD event recording sector
p=3 HDD copy sector
p=4 Disk connected to COPY 1
p=5 Disk connected to COPY 2
sss: Additional disk space (%)
ID request
QID
QIB
QIC
QID:WJ-HD309
or
QID:WJ-HD316
Interface ID request
QIB:WJ-HD309
or
QIB:WJ-HD316
Production category
request
QIC:2
Alarm information request QLD:0
QLD:n
n=0 (No alarm)
n=1 (Alarm end)
n=2 (Under alarm operation)
Software version inquiry
Status inquiry
QRV
QSR
QRV:n.nn
QSR:Status 1:Status 2
n.nn: Software version
...
Following response commands are sends back
...
for "Status 1:Status 2
"
msu:0 Under normal operation
msu:1 Under setting
oms:0001 Monitor 1
oms:0002 Monitor 2
ocs:ccccc ccccc: Camera number
otc:n Multiscreen segment display pattern
n=0: 4 segments
n=1: 7segments
n=2: 9 segments
n=3: 10 segments
n=4: 13 segments
n=5: 16 segments
oqt: 01F Sequence activated
ozm: 0 Zoom OFF
ozm: 2 x2 zoom
ozm: 4 x4 zoom
mad: 0 Alarm suspension OFF
mad: 1 Alarm suspension ON
zcd: Cascade activated
zqs: 1 CH recording activated:2 CH recording
...
activated 16 CH recording activated
Recording status nn=00 (Recording stop)
nn=01 (Manual recording activated)
nn=02 (Event recording activated)
nn=03 (Schedule recording activated)
nn=04 (Emergency recording activated)
148
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
zqm: Monitor status: camera CH: Playback
time
Monitor status n=0 Live
n=1 Live sequence
n=2 Playback
n=3 Other statuses
Camera CH
Playback time: yyyymmddhhnnss
ztl:n Search editing area ON
n=0 Search editing area OFF
n=1 Recording event search list ON
n=2 Recording event search thumbnail
ON
n=3 VMD search list ON
n=4 VMD search thumbnail ON
n=5 Marking search list ON
n=6 Marking search thumbnail ON
n=7 Search playback display ON
zdt:0 Text display OFF
zdt:1 Text display ON
Recording mode inquiry
Monitor status inquiry
QRM
ZQM
QRM:n
n=0 Normal recording mode
n=2 Continuous (External timer) recording
mode
ZQM:m:a1a2a3a4:yyyy
mmddhhnnss
m=0 Live
m=1 Live sequence
m=2 Playback
m=3 Other statuses
a1a2a3a4: Camera CH information (binary)
yyyymmddhhnnss: Playback time
Recording status inquiry
ZQS
ZQS:1 CH recording activated: Recording status nn=00 (Recording stop)
...
2 CH recording activated 16
nn=01 (Manual recording activated)
nn=02 (Event recording activated)
nn=03 (Schedule recording activated)
nn=04 (Emergency recording activated)
CH recording activated
Record number informa-
tion
–
ZRN:sss:nn:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr
:nnyyyymmddhhnnss:
ccc:x;yyy:t
sss: Unit address
nn=Sequence number
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record number
yyyymmddhhnnss: Recording event date and
time
ccc: Camera CH
x=0 Manual recording
x=1 Schedule recording
x=2 VMD recording
x=3 Alarm port recording
x=4 Command alarm recording
x=5 VIDEO LOSS recording
x=6 Emergency recording
yyy: Event-activated CH
t=0 Text included
t=1 Text not included
nn=Sequence number
Camera SYNC status
inquiry
QSY:a1a2a3a4a5
:b1b2b3b4b5
QSY:a1a2a3a4a5
b1b2b3b4b5:s1s2s3 sm
a1a2a3a4a5 - b1b2b3b4b5: Range of camera CH
to inquire SYNC status
s1s2s3 sm: SYNC status of each camera
...
...
(sm=0: SYNC status not found
sm=1: SYNC status found)
149
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
Parameter (ASCII)
Record information
inquiry
ZGP:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr
ZGP:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:
ccc:q:nnnn:yyyymmdd
hhnnss:nnss:t:ssssss
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record number
ccc: Camera CH
q: picture quality (0 (Very Fine), 1 (Fine), 2
(Normal), 3 (Extended))
nnnn: Recording rate
yyyymmddhhnnss: Recording start date and
time
nnss: Recording total time
t=0 Text included
t=1 Text not included
ssssss: Record size [KB]
Communication
Item
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)
RCK RCK
Parameter (ASCII)
Communication check
150
FLOWCHART OF THE SETUP MENU
Maintenance
REC Rate
Recording
REC Setup
Event
Event Setup
Schedule
Time Table
Event Setup
VMD
Maintenance
Disk Info
Recording
Emergency REC
Schedule
REC PROGRAM
Event Setup
Video Loss
REC PROGRAM
Recording Program
Maintenance
Version info
Schedule
EVENT PROGRAM
Event Setup
Terminal/Command
Alarm
EVENT PROGRAM
Event Program
Event
VMD Setup
Event Program
VMD
Maintenance
Disk End Mode
VMD Area Setup
For each camera
Event Program
Video Loss
Event
Alarm Setup
Maintenance
Disk Capacity
Event Program
Terminal/Command
Alarm
Event
Terminal Setup
Maintenance
Disk Delete
Schedule
Special Days
Maintenance
Event Log
Maintenance
Error Log
Maintenance
Access Log
Maintenance
Monitor 1
Display
OSD Setup
Comm
Camera Control
System
Basic Setup
OSD Setup
Monitor 1
Camera Title
Live Sequence
Maintenance
Monitor 2
Display
Monitor 1
Comm
PS·Data Setup
System
Time & Date
Monitor 2
PS·Data Setup
Time & Date
Live Sequence
Camera Number Setup
Summer Time
(Day Light Saving)
Table
Display
Monitor 2
Comm
RS485 Setup
System
User Regist.
RS485 Setup
Control Camera CH
Comm
System
RS232 Setup
User Edit
Comm
System
NW Setup 1
User Delete
Comm
System
NW Setup 2
Host Regist.
Comm
System
NTP Setup
Host Edit
System
Host Delete
System
User Level
System
Save/Load
151
PARAMETERS AND THE DEFAULT SETTINGS OF THE SETUP MENU
These are the setting parameters and the default settings of the items on the SETUP MENU.
Refer to these as reference.
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
Maintenance
Disk Info
Warning for Disk Life Time
HDD Safety Mode
Normal Recording Area
Event Recording Area
Copy Area
10 000 h/20 000 h/30 000 h
ON/OFF
20 000 h
OFF
Disk End Mode
Disk Capacity
Data Delete
CONTINUE/STOP
CONTINUE/STOP
CONTINUE/STOP
CONTINUE/STOP
CONTINUE/STOP
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %
CONTINUE
CONTINUE
STOP
COPY1
STOP
COPY2
STOP
Normal Recording Area
Event Recording Area
Copy Area
10 %
10 %
10 %
COPY1
10 %
COPY2
10 %
Auto Delete
OFF/1DAY/2DAYS/···.../10DAYS/14DAYS/
30DAYS/45DAYS/60DAYS/90DAYS/
120DAYS/150DAYS/180DAYS
OFF
Recording
REC Setup
Recording
ON/OFF
ON
Power ON Manual REC
Manual Recording Channel
Color Mode
ON/OFF
OFF
MON2/ALL
ALL
COLOR FINE/COLOR STD/B/W
ON/OFF
COLOR STD
Embedded REC(Title)
ON
ON
Embedded REC(Time & Date) ON/OFF
REC Priority
Manual REC/Schedule REC/Event REC
1: Event REC
2: Manual REC
3: Schedule REC
Audio Allocation
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2.....CAM16
HD309: OFF/CAM1/.....CAM9
AUDIO1 to 4: OFF
FIELD
Emergency REC
Resolution
FRAME 3D ON/FRAME 3D OFF/FIELD/SIF
Recording Time
1 s/2 s/..../10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/..../10 m/
20 m/30 m/40 m/50 m/60 m/MANUAL/
CONTINUE
10 s
Recording Rate and Quality
Recording rate: 1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/
6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips
Quality: SFA/SFB/FQA/FQB/NQA/NQB/
EXA/EXB
2.5 ips
SFB
OFF
Auto Copy
OFF/ON
Event
Event Setup
Alarm Output
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/
2 m/...../5 m/EXT
VMD: OFF
Video Loss: 2 s
Terminal Command Alarm: 2 s
Output Terminal
HD316: TRM1/TRM2/...../TRM16
HD309: TRM1/TRM2/...../TRM9
152
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
Event Setup
Buzzer
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/
2 m/...../5 m/EXT
VMD: OFF
Video Loss: 2 s
Terminal Command Alarm: 2 s
Monitor1 Action
Monitor2 Action
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16
HD309: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM9
VMD: OFF
Video Loss: Camera channel with a video
loss occurrence
Terminal Command Alarm: Same number
for camera channel number and alarm
number
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16
HD309: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM9
VMD: OFF
Video Loss: Camera channel with a video
loss occurrence
Terminal Command Alarm: Same number
for camera channel number and alarm
number
VMD Setup
(SETUP AREA)
(SETUP ALL AREA)
(DELETE AREA)
(DELETE ALL AREA)
(SENSITIVITY)
(VMD MODE)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(EXIT)
-
Alarm Setup
Alarm Auto Reset
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/
4 m/5 m
OFF
Alarm Disarm Time
Terminal Setup
2 s/3 s/...../10 s
2 s
Terminal Setup
N.O./N.C.
N.O.
Schedule
Time Table
Period
12:00AM to 12:00AM
12:00AM to 12:00AM (Everyday/Time
zone1)
--:-- to --:-- (Except above)
REC PROGRAM
PROG1/PROG2/PROG3/PROG4
PROG1/PROG2/PROG3/PROG4
ON/OFF
PROG1
PROG1
OFF
EVENT PROGRAM
FTP SEND BY PERIODIC
TIMER
ERROR REPORT MAIL
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
WARNING REPORT MAIL
NW BANDWIDTH CONTROL
OFF/32kbps/64kbps/128kbps/256kbps/
512kbps/1024kbps/2Mbps/5Mbps/10Mbps
Resolution
RATE
FRAME 3D ON/FRAME 3D OFF/FIELD/FRAME
FIELD
REC PROGRAM
OFF/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/ Manual REC: 12.5 ips
12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips/100 ips
Schedule REC: 12.5 ips
Event REC: 25 ips
RATE
OFF/AUTO/0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/
0.5 ips/1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/ SCHEDULE: AUTO
MANUAL: AUTO
8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips
EVENT (PRE): 1 ips
EVENT (POST): 1 ips
QUALITY
SFA/SFB/FQA/FQB/NQA/NQB/EXA/EXB
FQB
DURATION (TIME for the unit) 1 s/2 s/...../10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m,/...../
10 m/20 m/...../60 m/MANUAL/CONTINUE
EVENT (PRE): 10 s
EVENT (POST): 30 s
EVENT PROGRAM Action Mode (The unit)
ALARM/ACT DET
Video Loss, Terminal/Command Alarm:
ALARM
VMD: ACT DET
REC CH
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
--/1/2/...../64
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
ON/OFF
ON
OFF
--
Auto Copy
Preset Position
Serial Notice
Mail Notice
OFF
OFF
OFF
FTP Alarm Sending
153
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
Special Days
DATE
Mode
1/1 to 12/31
--
--
MON/TUE/WED/THU/FRI/SAT/SUN
Switcher
Monitor1
Live Sequence
[Operating with the buttons of the unit]
WJ-HD316:
1/2/.../16/1-4/5-8/9-12/13-16/1-9/10-16/--
WJ-HD309:
HD316: STEP1: CAM1,
STEP2: CAM2, ...... STEP16: CAM16
HD309: STEP1: CAM1,
STEP2: CAM2, ...... STEP9:CAM9
1/2/.../9/1-4/5-8/9-9/1-9/--
[Operating via a network]
WJ-HD316:
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/--
WJ-HD309:
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/9SCREEN/--
--/1/2/.../64
--
1 s/2 s/.../30 s
2 s
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
INT/EXT/MON2
ON/OFF
INT
ON
Login Screen
WJ-HD316:
16SCREEN
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/
16SCREEN/SEQ/--
WJ-HD309:
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ/--
Secret View
ON/OFF
OFF
Monitor2
Live Sequence
[Operating with the buttons of the unit]
WJ-HD316:
1/2/.../16/1-4/5-8/9-12/13-16/1-9/10-16/--
WJ-HD309:
HD316: STEP1: CAM1,
STEP2: CAM2, .....STEP16:CAM16
HD309: STEP1: CAM1,
STEP2: CAM2, ..... STEP9:CAM9
1/2/.../9/1-4/5-8/9-9/1-9/--
[Operating via a network]
WJ-HD316:
CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/--
WJ-HD309:
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/9SCREEN/--
--/1/2/.../64
--
1 s/2 s/.../30 s
2 s
Sequence Timing
Auto Skip
INT/EXT
ON/OFF
INT
ON
Login Screen
WJ-HD316:
QUAD1-4
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/
16SCREEN/SEQ/--
WJ-HD309:
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ/--
Display
OSD Setup
Time & Date Display Position
Camera Title Display Position
L-UPPER/R-UPPER/L-LOWER/R-LOWER
L-UPPER
R-LOWER
L-UPPER/R-UPPER/L-LOWER/R-LOWER/
CENTER
Line Color on the Multi Screen WHITE/GRAY/BLACK
WHITE
154
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
Monitor1
Time & Date Display
Camera Title Display
Alarm Display
ON/OFF
ON
ON/OFF
ON
ON/OFF
ON
Monitor2
Display Mode
MODE1/MODE2/MODE3
UPPER/LOWER
MODE1
LOWER
T&D and Status Display
Position
Camera Title Display
ON/OFF
ON
Comm
Camera Control
COMP
TYPE
S/M/L
HD316: CAM1to CAM8: S
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: S
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: COAX/RS485/OFF,
CAM9 to CAM12: RS485/PSD/OFF,
CAM13 to CAM16: RS485/PSD/OFF
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: COAX/RS485/OFF,
CAM7 to CAM9: RS485/PSD/OFF
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: COAX,
CAM9 to CAM12: PSD,
CAM13 to CAM16: PSD
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: COAX,
CAM7 to CAM9: PSD
PS·Data Setup
Unit Address(System)
Unit Address(Controller)
Cascade
001 to 099
001
001
OFF
9 600
8
001 to 099
ON/OFF
Baud Rate
2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200/38 400
Data Bit
8
Parity
NONE/EVEN/ODD
NONE
1
Stop Bit
1/2
Retry Timing
Alarm Data
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1000 ms/
OFF/0 s/1 s/5 s
OFF
1 s
Camera Number Setup
001 to 099
HD316: 1: 001 to 16: 016
HD309: 1: 001 to 9: 009
RS485 Setup
Baud Rate
4 800/9 600/19 200
PORT1/PORT2
9 600
Control Camera CH
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: PORT1,
CAM9 to CAM16: PORT2
HD309: CAM1 to CAM9: PORT1
Data Bit
8
8
Parity
NONE
NONE
Stop Bit
1
1
RS232C Setup
NW Setup1
NW Setup2
Unit Address(System)
Baud Rate
Data Bit
001 to 099
001
9 600/19 200/38 400
9 600
7/8
8
Parity
NONE/EVEN/ODD
NONE
Stop Bit
1/2
1
Retry Timing
HTTP Port Number
User Authentication
Host Authentication
Line Speed
Live Video Quality
Video Rate
DHCP
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1000 ms/
OFF
00000 to 65535
00080
ON/OFF
OFF
ON/OFF
OFF
AUTO
AUTO
FQB
FQB
FAST/MIDDLE/SLOW/VERY SLOW
ON/OFF
MIDDLE
OFF
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
ON/OFF
192.168.0.250
255.255.255.000
192.168.000.001
OFF
DNS
Primary
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
ON/OFF
000.000.000.000
000.000.000.000
OFF
Secondary
DDNS
155
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
NW Setup2
User Name
-
-
User Password
Access Interval
Host Name
-
-
10 m/30 m/1 h/6 h/24 h
-
1 h
HD316: HD316
HD309: HD309
Domain Name
COMMUNITY
-
-
localdomain
public
Network SNMP
Setup
CONTACT
-
-
SYSTEM NAME
LOCATION
-
-
-
-
NTP Setup
Time Adjustment
Time Zone
ON/OFF
OFF
GMT-12:00/GMT-11:00/...../GMT-4:00/GMT-3:30/
GMT-3:00/...../GMT-1:00/GMT 0:00/GMT+1:00/
GMT+2:00/...../GMT+9:00/GMT+9:30/
GMT+10:00/...../GMT+13:00
GMT-0:00
NTP Server Address
Refresh Interval
-
-
1 h/2 h/6 h/12 h/24 h
6 h
Network FTP Setup FTP Server Address
User Name
-
-
-
-
User Password
Mode
-
-
SEQUENTIAL/PASSIVE
SEQUENTIAL
Server Directory
File Name
-
-
TIME & DATE BASE/SERIAL NUMBER
TIME & DATE BASE
Interval
-
01 s
Channel to Send
Server Directory
File Name
CAM1 to CAM16
-
-
-
TIME & DATE BASE/SERIAL NUMBER
TIME & DATE BASE
Duration-Pre
OFF/1 s/2 s/3 s/4 s/5 s/6 s/7 s/8 s/9 s/10 s
OFF
Duration-Post
OFF/1 s/2 s/3 s/4 s/5 s/6 s/7 s/8 s/9 s/10 s
5 s
Network Mail Setup Attach Alarm Image
Mail Server Address
Send to
ON/OFF
OFF
-
-
-
-
Address1
-
-
From Address
-
-
POP before SMTP
POP Server Address
User Name
ON/OFF
OFF
-
-
-
-
-
-
User Password
System
Basic Setup
ADMIN Password
PSD User
-
12345
-
ADMIN
Auto Login
ON/OFF
ON
Auto Login User
Auto Logout
Priority
-
ADMIN
ON/OFF
OFF
Follow the priority./Pre-priority/Post-priority
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m
Follow the priority.
5 s
"GO TO LAST" before
Language
JAPANESE/ENGLISH/FRANÇAIS/ESPAÑOL/
DEUTSCH/ITALIANO
ENGLISH
OFF
Beep (Operation)
Buzzer (Error)
Shutdown Time
Auto Copy
ON/OFF
OFF/1 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/...../5 m/EXT
10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m
ON/OFF
2 s
10 s
OFF
156
Setup Menu
Setup Item
Parameter
Default Setting
Time & Date
Date Format
Time Format
Auto Adjust Time
Master Time
YY.MM.DD/MMM.DD.YY/DD.MMM.YY
24 h/12 h
DD.MMM.YY
12 h
ON/OFF
OFF
0:00/1:00/...../23:00
0:00
Summer Time(Day Light Saving) ON/OFF/AUTO
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)
OFF
Table
-
-
-
User Regist.
User Edit
User Name
Password
Level
-
-
-
User Delete
1/2/3
1/2/...../16
1
1
Priority
Default Screen
WJ-HD316
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/
16SCREEN/SEQ
WJ-HD309
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ
CAM1
Camera Partitioning
Host IP Address
Level
--/View/View/Operate
View/Operate
Host Regist.
Host Edit
-
-
1
1
1/2/3
Host Delete
Priority
1/2/...../16
Default Screen
WJ-HD316
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/
16SCREEN/SEQ
WJ-HD309
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ
CAM1
Camera Partitioning
WJ-HD300 Setup
WJ-HD300 Setup Status
Camera Setup
--/View/View/Operate
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
View/Operate
LV1
User Level
LV1,LV2
LV1
Event Log Status
Access Log Status
Error Log Status
LV1,LV2
LV1,LV2
LV1,LV2
LV1,LV2
LV1
Alarm Reset
Alarm Suspended Time
Copy
LV1
Normal Recording Erase
Event Recording Erase
Manual REC Operation
Playback Operation
N/W Access
LV1
LV1
LV1,LV2
LV1,LV2,LV3
LV1,LV2,LV3
157
TROUBLESHOOTING
Check the following before requesting repair.
Contact your dealer if a problem cannot be solved even after checking and trying the solution or a problem is not described
below, and when having a problem with installations.
Check item/Remedy
Page
Problem
• Check if the power plug is properly connected to the AC
outlet.
–
Power is not turned on.
• Check if the power cord is properly inserted into the power
socket of the unit.
–
The HDD SAFETY MODE win-
dow is displayed after turning
on the power of the unit.
• The HDD SAFETY MODE is set to ON.
In this case, set the HDD SAFETY MODE to OFF.
Refer to p. 68.
• Check if the lens covers of the cameras have been
removed.
–
• Check if the power is supplied to cameras and connected
devices.
–
No camera image is displayed
on MON 1, MON 2, and the
VGA monitor
Refer to p. 70.
• Check if the cable connections are correct.
• Check the brightness and contrast settings of the moni-
tors.
–
Refer to p. 123
and 125.
• Can the users display camera images on the monitors?
Check the level settings of the users logging in.
The log-in menu does not
appear even if you press the
button of the unit.
• Check if any user has logged in with the system controller.
–
–
The camera image is dim.
• Check if dust may be sticking to the camera lens.
• Can the users display the SETUP MENU on the monitors?
Check the level settings of the users logging in.
Refer to p. 123
and 125.
Cannot open SETUP MENU.
• Check if monitor 1 is used to display the SETUP MENU.
The SETUP MENU cannot be displayed on monitor 1.
Refer to page
10.
158
Check item/Remedy
Page
Problem
• Check if the HDD has any available disk space.
Refer to p. 95.
• Check if the recording setup is set to ON.
• Check the schedule settings.
Refer to p. 98.
Refer to p. 105.
Refer to p. 98.
Cannot start recording.
• Check the recording priority settings.
• When the setting menu is displayed by a non-interlace
signal, the setting menu may be unable to function nor-
mally.
Since the setting menu of the matrix switcher is displayed
by a non-interlace signal, recording or displaying with this
unit may be impossible.
Cannot record the SETUP
MENU of a matrix switcher
–
Refer to p. 28.
• Check if images have been recorded on the HDD.
Refer to p. 123
and 125.
• Can the users record images?
Check the level settings of the users logging in.
Cannot playback images.
• Can the users display camera images on the monitors?
Check the level settings of the users logging in.
Refer to p. 123
and 125.
• Check the connection of the camera you are going to con-
trol. Coaxial communication control is available for cam-
eras connected to VIDEO IN 1 to 8 for the WJ-HD316 (1
to 6 for the WJ-HD309).
Refer to p. 70.
• Check if the camera you are going to control is a combina-
tion camera.
Refer to p. 70.
Refer to p. 116.
Cannot control cameras.
• Check the camera control settings.
Refer to p. 123
and 125.
• Can the users control the cameras?
Check the level settings of the users logging in.
• Check the BUSY indicator. When the indicator is lighting,
a higher-priority user is controlling the cameras. You can-
not control the cameras until the indicator goes out.
Refer to p. 8.
159
Check item/Remedy
Page
Problem
• Check if alarm input signals are properly input to the
ALARM or ALARM/CONTROL at the rear panel.
Refer to p. 83
and 87.
Alarm operations are not acti-
vated.
Refer to p. 87.
Refer to p. 107.
• Check the settings of the ALARM connector.
• Check if the operation mode is set to ALARM (alarm
mode).
• Check the camera connections.
Refer to p. 70.
"VIDEO LOSS" appears on the
monitor.
• If the camera connections are proper, refer to the dealer.
Cable wires may be snapped or the unit may have some
trouble.
–
• Check if the ambient operating temperature is between
+5°C and +45 °C (41 °F - 113 °F).
• When the inside of unit exceeds 45 °C (113 °F), "THER-
MAL" may appear even within the ambient temperature
mentioned above.
Refer to p. 5
and 14.
"THERMAL" appears on the
monitor.
• If "THERMAL" frequently appear on monitors, refer to the
dealer. The unit may have some trouble.
• Check if the built-in backup battery has been charged
enough. If not so, supply power to the unit for 48 hours or
more to recharge the battery.
Refer to p. 5.
Refer to p. 5.
The clock does not keep cor-
rect time.
• Check if the built-in backup battery has been worn out.
The battery life is approx. 5 years. (The battery lifetime
may differ depending on the condition of the environ-
ment.)
• Check if HDDs were added or removed. If so, the HDD
DISK MENU will be displayed automatically.
Refer to p. 131.
When you turn on the power of
the unit, the HDD DISK MENU
is displayed.
• If the HDD DISK MENU is displayed even though no
HDDs were added or removed, refer to the dealer. The
HDD may have some trouble.
–
160
Check item/Remedy
Page
Problem
• Check if "Disk End Mode" is set to STOP.
Refer to p. 95.
The additional disk space of
HDD is not displayed.
–
• Check if there is a partition in the HDD.
• Check if the "Disk End Mode" is set to STOP.
Refer to p. 95.
The available disk space of
HDD is not displayed on the
right bar.
• Check if there is a partition in the HDD.
–
Refer to the Net-
work Setup In-
• Check the network settings of the unit and PC.
structions (PDF).
Cannot establish a connection
via the network.
• Check the host registration setting. When host authentica-
tion is set to ON, you cannot establish the connection
from computers other than the PC registered as the host.
Refer to p. 119
and 124.
Response or Image update
takes time.
–
• Check if the network is crowded.
When the unit fails to find all of the connected extension units
(WJ-HDE300 series) previously mounted for the following rea-
sons, it may take time to start up because the unit will be
restarted while displaying the splash startup screen. They are
normal operations.
Rebooting of the unit occurs
while displaying the splash
startup screen.
–
• When dedicated cables connecting the unit and the extension
units are not firmly connected or detached
• When all of the extension units previously mounted are
disconnected
Inspect the power cord, power plug and connectors periodically.
The power cord insulation is
damaged.
• The power cord, plug and connectors are worn out. This may result in electric
shock or a fire. Unplug the power plug from the AC outlet immediately, and
refer to qualified service personnel.
The power cord, plug and con-
nectors get hot during use.
The power cord gets hot when
bent or stretched.
161
SPECIFICATION
General
Power source:
220 V - 240 V AC, 50 Hz
85 W
Power consumption
Ambient operating
temperature
+5°C to +45°C (41 °F - 113 °F)
Ambient operating
humidity
Less than 85 %
Dimensions
420 mm (W) X 88 mm (H) X 350 mm (D) [16-9/16" (W) X 3-7/16" (H) X
13-3/4" (D)] (excluding rubber feet and projections)
Weight
9.5 kg (21 lbs.)
Input/Output
Video
Video input connectors
1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, with auto termination loop-thru, vertical timing pulse mul-
tiplexed, x8 (1 to 8 CH) (BNC)
1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, with auto-termination loop-thru,
x8 (9 to 16 CH) (BNC)
Cascade input connector 1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω (BNC)
Video output connectors 1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, active loop-thru output, x8 (1 to 8 CH) (BNC)*
1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, active loop-thru output, x8 (9 to 16 CH) (BNC)
1
Monitor output connectors 1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, x2 (BNC)
Monitor output connector RGB output, x1 (15-pin D-sub)
(VGA)
S-video output connector Y = 1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, C=0.286 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, x1 (S-video output connec-
tor)
Video output connector
(front panel)
1 V [P-P] / 75 Ω, x1 (RCA pin)
Audio
Audio input connectors
Audio output connectors
Expansion connector
Copy connectors
–10 dB, 10 KΩ, x4 (RCA pin)
–10 dB, 600 Ω, unbalanced, x2 (RCA pin)
Others
High-speed serial interface, 480 Mbps (theoretical value), x1
High-speed serial interface, 480 Mbps (theoretical value), x2
Control connectors
Emergency recording input*2, additional space warning output*3 (for
devices connected to copy connectors), HDD trouble output*3, camera
trouble output*3, trouble output*3, electricity failure recovery completion
output*4, time adjust input/output*5, sequence switching input/output*5,
electricity failure detection input*2, external recording mode switching*2
(25-pin D-sub) , +5 V output *7
Alarm port
1 to 8 CH alarm input*6, 1 to 16 CH alarm input*2, 1 to 16 alarm output*3,
alarm recovery input*2, alarm suspension input*5 (25-pin D-sub)
RS-485 ports
DATA ports
RS-485 (full duplex/half duplex*8), x2 (RJ-11)
RS-485, x2 (RJ-11)
SERIAL connector
Ethernet port
RS-232C, x1 (9-pin D-sub)
10 Base-T/100 Base-Tx (RJ-45)
1
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
When power is not supplied, the video output signal was not sent from the unit even if a video input signal is supplied.
Non-voltage N.O. Contact, 100 mA, +5 V pull-up
Open collector output, maximum under conditions of 24 V DC and 100 mA or less
High (+12 V, 6.3 mA)
30 KΩ, 5 V pull-up, –100 mA, N.O. Contact
5 V pull-up, –100 mA, Non-voltage N.O. Contact input
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
200 mA at maximum
Changeable with the mode switch
162
STANDARD ACCESSORIES
CD-ROM* ............................................................................ 1
Operating Instructions (this manual) .................................. 1
The following are for installation:
Power Cord ......................................................................... 2
Rack Mounting Bracket ...................................................... 2
Screw for Rack Mounting Bracket ...................................... 4
Cable Clamp ....................................................................... 1
Screw for Cable Clamp ...................................................... 1
Hard Disk Drive Fixing Screw ............................................. 4
*The following are included on the CD-ROM:
Viewer software
Plug-in software
Network Operating Instructions (PDF)
Network Setup Operations (PDF)
163
Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd.
Osaka, Japan
http://www.panasonic.co.jp/global/
2004 © Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.
NM0104-2034
3TR001707CAA
Printed in Japan
|
Intel DDR266 PC2100 User Manual
Jenn Air CCG2523 User Manual
JVC LCT2142 001A H User Manual
KitchenAid KECC507KBL03 User Manual
LG Electronics 47WV30BS User Manual
LG Electronics W2242T User Manual
National Instruments Computer Hardware 321372C 01 User Manual
Panasonic Cordless Telephone KX TG1312BX User Manual
Philips 24CE3276 User Manual
Philips 109F52 User Manual